C++-ify bp_location
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 #include "defs.h"
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "hashtab.h"
24 #include "symtab.h"
25 #include "frame.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
28 #include "gdbtypes.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
30 #include "gdbcore.h"
31 #include "gdbcmd.h"
32 #include "value.h"
33 #include "command.h"
34 #include "inferior.h"
35 #include "infrun.h"
36 #include "gdbthread.h"
37 #include "target.h"
38 #include "language.h"
39 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
40 #include "filenames.h"
41 #include "annotate.h"
42 #include "symfile.h"
43 #include "objfiles.h"
44 #include "source.h"
45 #include "linespec.h"
46 #include "completer.h"
47 #include "ui-out.h"
48 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
49 #include "block.h"
50 #include "solib.h"
51 #include "solist.h"
52 #include "observable.h"
53 #include "memattr.h"
54 #include "ada-lang.h"
55 #include "top.h"
56 #include "valprint.h"
57 #include "jit.h"
58 #include "parser-defs.h"
59 #include "gdb_regex.h"
60 #include "probe.h"
61 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
62 #include "continuations.h"
63 #include "stack.h"
64 #include "skip.h"
65 #include "ax-gdb.h"
66 #include "dummy-frame.h"
67 #include "interps.h"
68 #include "common/format.h"
69 #include "thread-fsm.h"
70 #include "tid-parse.h"
71 #include "cli/cli-style.h"
72
73 /* readline include files */
74 #include "readline/readline.h"
75 #include "readline/history.h"
76
77 /* readline defines this. */
78 #undef savestring
79
80 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
81 #include "extension.h"
82 #include <algorithm>
83 #include "progspace-and-thread.h"
84 #include "common/array-view.h"
85 #include "common/gdb_optional.h"
86
87 /* Enums for exception-handling support. */
88 enum exception_event_kind
89 {
90 EX_EVENT_THROW,
91 EX_EVENT_RETHROW,
92 EX_EVENT_CATCH
93 };
94
95 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
96
97 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *,
98 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)>);
99
100 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
101
102 static void
103 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
104 struct linespec_result *canonical,
105 enum bptype type_wanted);
106
107 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
108 struct linespec_result *,
109 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
110 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
111 enum bptype,
112 enum bpdisp, int, int,
113 int,
114 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
115 int, int, int, unsigned);
116
117 static std::vector<symtab_and_line> decode_location_default
118 (struct breakpoint *b, const struct event_location *location,
119 struct program_space *search_pspace);
120
121 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint
122 (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals);
123
124 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
125
126 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
127 enum bptype,
128 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
129 static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
130 const struct symtab_and_line *);
131
132 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
133 static. */
134 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
135 struct symtab_and_line,
136 enum bptype,
137 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
138
139 static struct breakpoint *
140 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
141 enum bptype type,
142 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
143 int loc_enabled);
144
145 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
146
147 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
148 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
149 enum bptype bptype);
150
151 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
152 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
153 struct obj_section *, int);
154
155 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
156 struct bp_location *loc2);
157
158 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
159 const struct address_space *aspace,
160 CORE_ADDR addr);
161
162 static int breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *,
163 const address_space *,
164 CORE_ADDR, int);
165
166 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *);
167 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason);
168
169 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
170
171 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
172
173 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
174
175 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
176 enum bptype type,
177 int *other_type_used);
178
179 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
180 int count);
181
182 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
183 static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
184 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
185
186 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
187
188 /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
189 insert locations now. */
190 enum ugll_insert_mode
191 {
192 /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
193 remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
194 inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
195 should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
196 have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
197 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
198 returns true on them.
199
200 This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
201 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
202 breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
203 be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
204 target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
205 GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
206 the inferior. */
207 UGLL_DONT_INSERT,
208
209 /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
210 claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
211 UGLL_MAY_INSERT,
212
213 /* Insert locations now, irrespective of
214 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
215 stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
216 insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
217 UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
218 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
219 as no thread is running yet. */
220 UGLL_INSERT
221 };
222
223 static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode);
224
225 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode);
226
227 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
228
229 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
230
231 static void trace_pass_command (const char *, int);
232
233 static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
234
235 static int is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
236
237 static struct bp_location **get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address);
238
239 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
240 otherwise. */
241
242 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
243
244 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
245 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
246 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
247 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
248
249 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
250 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
251
252 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
253 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
254
255 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
256 breakpoints. */
257 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
258
259 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
260 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
261
262 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
263 struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
264
265 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
266 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
267 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
268 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
269 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
270 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
271
272 static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
273 static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
274 static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
275 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
276 dprintf_style_gdb,
277 dprintf_style_call,
278 dprintf_style_agent,
279 NULL
280 };
281 static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
282
283 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
284 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
285 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
286 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
287
288 static char *dprintf_function;
289
290 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
291 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
292 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
293 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
294 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
295 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
296 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
297
298 static char *dprintf_channel;
299
300 /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
301 has disconnected. */
302 static int disconnected_dprintf = 1;
303
304 struct command_line *
305 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
306 {
307 return b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
308 }
309
310 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
311 current breakpoint. */
312
313 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
314
315 const char *
316 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
317 {
318 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
319 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
320 a breakpoint. */
321 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
322
323 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
324 }
325
326 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
327 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
328 if such is available. */
329 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
330
331 static void
332 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
333 struct cmd_list_element *c,
334 const char *value)
335 {
336 fprintf_filtered (file,
337 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
338 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
339 value);
340 }
341
342 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
343 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
344 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
345 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
346 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
347 static void
348 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
349 struct cmd_list_element *c,
350 const char *value)
351 {
352 fprintf_filtered (file,
353 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
354 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
355 value);
356 }
357
358 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
359 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
360 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
361 use hardware breakpoints. */
362 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
363 static void
364 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
365 struct cmd_list_element *c,
366 const char *value)
367 {
368 fprintf_filtered (file,
369 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
370 value);
371 }
372
373 /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
374 stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
375 they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
376 the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
377 breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
378 target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
379 processing user input. */
380 static int always_inserted_mode = 0;
381
382 static void
383 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
384 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
385 {
386 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
387 value);
388 }
389
390 /* See breakpoint.h. */
391
392 int
393 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
394 {
395 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
396 {
397 /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
398 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
399 no threads under GDB's control yet. */
400 return 1;
401 }
402 else if (target_has_execution)
403 {
404 if (always_inserted_mode)
405 {
406 /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
407 are stopped. */
408 return 1;
409 }
410
411 if (threads_are_executing ())
412 return 1;
413
414 /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are
415 stopped, we still have events to process. */
416 for (thread_info *tp : all_non_exited_threads ())
417 if (tp->resumed
418 && tp->suspend.waitstatus_pending_p)
419 return 1;
420 }
421 return 0;
422 }
423
424 static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
425
426 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
427 static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
428 static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
429 static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
430 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
431 condition_evaluation_auto,
432 condition_evaluation_host,
433 condition_evaluation_target,
434 NULL
435 };
436
437 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
438 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
439
440 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
441 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
442 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
443
444 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
445 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
446 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
447 evaluation mode. */
448
449 static const char *
450 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
451 {
452 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
453 {
454 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
455 return condition_evaluation_target;
456 else
457 return condition_evaluation_host;
458 }
459 else
460 return mode;
461 }
462
463 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
464
465 static const char *
466 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
467 {
468 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
469 }
470
471 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
472 otherwise. */
473
474 static int
475 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
476 {
477 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
478
479 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
480 }
481
482 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
483 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
484
485 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
486 static int overlay_events_enabled;
487
488 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
489 int target_exact_watchpoints = 0;
490
491 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
492 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
493 current breakpoint. */
494
495 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
496
497 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
498 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
499 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
500 B = TMP)
501
502 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
503 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
504 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
505
506 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
507 for (BP_TMP = bp_locations; \
508 BP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count && (B = *BP_TMP);\
509 BP_TMP++)
510
511 /* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected
512 program space. BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object. BP_LOCP_START points
513 to where the loop should start from.
514 If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the
515 appropriate location to start with. */
516
517 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS) \
518 for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \
519 BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START; \
520 BP_LOCP_START \
521 && (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count \
522 && (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS); \
523 BP_LOCP_TMP++)
524
525 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
526
527 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
528 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
529 if (is_tracepoint (B))
530
531 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
532
533 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
534
535 /* Array is sorted by bp_locations_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
536
537 static struct bp_location **bp_locations;
538
539 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATIONS. */
540
541 static unsigned bp_locations_count;
542
543 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
544 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid
545 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
546 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to scan for shadow bytes for
547 an address you need to read. */
548
549 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max;
550
551 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
552 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
553 BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
554 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to
555 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
556
557 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max;
558
559 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
560 from the bp_locations array, but for which a hit may still be
561 reported by a target. */
562 static std::vector<bp_location *> moribund_locations;
563
564 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
565
566 static int breakpoint_count;
567
568 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
569 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
570 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
571 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
572 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
573
574 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
575
576 static int tracepoint_count;
577
578 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
579 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
580 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
581
582 /* See declaration at breakpoint.h. */
583
584 struct breakpoint *
585 breakpoint_find_if (int (*func) (struct breakpoint *b, void *d),
586 void *user_data)
587 {
588 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
589
590 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
591 {
592 if (func (b, user_data) != 0)
593 break;
594 }
595
596 return b;
597 }
598
599 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
600 static int
601 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
602 {
603 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
604 }
605
606 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
607
608 static void
609 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
610 {
611 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
612 breakpoint_count = num;
613 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
614 }
615
616 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
617 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
618 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
619
620 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
621 breakpoint made. */
622
623 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
624 {
625 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
626 }
627
628 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
629 breakpoint made. */
630
631 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::~scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
632 {
633 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
634 }
635
636 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
637
638 void
639 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
640 {
641 struct breakpoint *b;
642
643 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
644 b->hit_count = 0;
645 }
646
647 \f
648 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
649 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
650
651 struct breakpoint *
652 get_breakpoint (int num)
653 {
654 struct breakpoint *b;
655
656 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
657 if (b->number == num)
658 return b;
659
660 return NULL;
661 }
662
663 \f
664
665 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
666 evaluating conditions on its side. */
667
668 static void
669 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
670 {
671 struct bp_location *loc;
672
673 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
674 evaluating conditions and if the user has
675 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
676 side. */
677 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
678 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
679 return;
680
681 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
682 return;
683
684 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
685 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
686 }
687
688 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
689 evaluating conditions on its side. */
690
691 static void
692 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
693 {
694 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
695 evaluating conditions and if the user has
696 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
697 side. */
698 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
699 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
700
701 return;
702
703 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
704 return;
705
706 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
707 }
708
709 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
710 condition_evaluation_mode. */
711
712 static void
713 set_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *args, int from_tty,
714 struct cmd_list_element *c)
715 {
716 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
717
718 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
719 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
720 {
721 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
722 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
723 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
724 return;
725 }
726
727 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
728 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
729
730 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
731 settings was "auto". */
732 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
733
734 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
735 if (new_mode != old_mode)
736 {
737 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
738 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
739 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
740
741 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
742 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
743 */
744
745 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
746 {
747 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
748 target. */
749 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
750 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
751 }
752 else
753 {
754 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
755 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
756 target knows about. */
757 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
758 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
759 loc->needs_update = 1;
760 }
761
762 /* Do the update. */
763 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
764 }
765
766 return;
767 }
768
769 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
770 what "auto" is translating to. */
771
772 static void
773 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
774 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
775 {
776 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
777 fprintf_filtered (file,
778 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
779 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
780 value,
781 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
782 else
783 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
784 value);
785 }
786
787 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by
788 bsearch. This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike
789 the more general bp_locations_compare function. */
790
791 static int
792 bp_locations_compare_addrs (const void *ap, const void *bp)
793 {
794 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
795 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
796
797 if (a->address == b->address)
798 return 0;
799 else
800 return ((a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address));
801 }
802
803 /* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses
804 less than ADDRESS. It returns the first bp_location that
805 is greater than or equal to ADDRESS. If none is found, just
806 return NULL. */
807
808 static struct bp_location **
809 get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address)
810 {
811 struct bp_location dummy_loc;
812 struct bp_location *dummy_locp = &dummy_loc;
813 struct bp_location **locp_found = NULL;
814
815 /* Initialize the dummy location's address field. */
816 dummy_loc.address = address;
817
818 /* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS. */
819 locp_found = ((struct bp_location **)
820 bsearch (&dummy_locp, bp_locations, bp_locations_count,
821 sizeof (struct bp_location **),
822 bp_locations_compare_addrs));
823
824 /* Nothing was found, nothing left to do. */
825 if (locp_found == NULL)
826 return NULL;
827
828 /* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the
829 location's list. Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one. */
830 while ((locp_found - 1) >= bp_locations
831 && (*(locp_found - 1))->address == address)
832 locp_found--;
833
834 return locp_found;
835 }
836
837 void
838 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp,
839 int from_tty)
840 {
841 xfree (b->cond_string);
842 b->cond_string = NULL;
843
844 if (is_watchpoint (b))
845 {
846 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
847
848 w->cond_exp.reset ();
849 }
850 else
851 {
852 struct bp_location *loc;
853
854 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
855 {
856 loc->cond.reset ();
857
858 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
859 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
860 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
861 }
862 }
863
864 if (*exp == 0)
865 {
866 if (from_tty)
867 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
868 }
869 else
870 {
871 const char *arg = exp;
872
873 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
874 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
875 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
876 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
877
878 if (is_watchpoint (b))
879 {
880 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
881
882 innermost_block.reset ();
883 arg = exp;
884 w->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
885 if (*arg)
886 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
887 w->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block.block ();
888 }
889 else
890 {
891 struct bp_location *loc;
892
893 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
894 {
895 arg = exp;
896 loc->cond =
897 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
898 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
899 if (*arg)
900 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
901 }
902 }
903 }
904 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
905
906 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
907 }
908
909 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
910
911 static void
912 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
913 completion_tracker &tracker,
914 const char *text, const char *word)
915 {
916 const char *space;
917
918 text = skip_spaces (text);
919 space = skip_to_space (text);
920 if (*space == '\0')
921 {
922 int len;
923 struct breakpoint *b;
924
925 if (text[0] == '$')
926 {
927 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
928 if (!isdigit (text[1]))
929 complete_internalvar (tracker, &text[1]);
930 return;
931 }
932
933 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
934 len = strlen (text);
935
936 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
937 {
938 char number[50];
939
940 xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
941
942 if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
943 {
944 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> copy (xstrdup (number));
945 tracker.add_completion (std::move (copy));
946 }
947 }
948
949 return;
950 }
951
952 /* We're completing the expression part. */
953 text = skip_spaces (space);
954 expression_completer (cmd, tracker, text, word);
955 }
956
957 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
958
959 static void
960 condition_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
961 {
962 struct breakpoint *b;
963 const char *p;
964 int bnum;
965
966 if (arg == 0)
967 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
968
969 p = arg;
970 bnum = get_number (&p);
971 if (bnum == 0)
972 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
973
974 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
975 if (b->number == bnum)
976 {
977 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
978 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
979 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
980 const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
981 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
982
983 if (extlang != NULL)
984 {
985 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
986 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
987 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
988 }
989 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
990
991 if (is_breakpoint (b))
992 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
993
994 return;
995 }
996
997 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
998 }
999
1000 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1001 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1002 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1003
1004 static void
1005 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
1006 {
1007 struct command_line *c;
1008
1009 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1010 {
1011 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1012 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1013 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1014
1015 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_0.get ());
1016 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_1.get ());
1017
1018 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1019 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1020 command directly. */
1021 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1022 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1023
1024 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1025 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1026 }
1027 }
1028
1029 struct longjmp_breakpoint : public breakpoint
1030 {
1031 ~longjmp_breakpoint () override;
1032 };
1033
1034 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1035
1036 static bool
1037 is_tracepoint_type (bptype type)
1038 {
1039 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1040 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1041 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1042 }
1043
1044 static bool
1045 is_longjmp_type (bptype type)
1046 {
1047 return type == bp_longjmp || type == bp_exception;
1048 }
1049
1050 int
1051 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1052 {
1053 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1054 }
1055
1056 /* Factory function to create an appropriate instance of breakpoint given
1057 TYPE. */
1058
1059 static std::unique_ptr<breakpoint>
1060 new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype type)
1061 {
1062 breakpoint *b;
1063
1064 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
1065 b = new tracepoint ();
1066 else if (is_longjmp_type (type))
1067 b = new longjmp_breakpoint ();
1068 else
1069 b = new breakpoint ();
1070
1071 return std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> (b);
1072 }
1073
1074 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1075 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1076 found. */
1077
1078 static void
1079 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1080 struct command_line *commands)
1081 {
1082 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1083 {
1084 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
1085 struct command_line *c;
1086 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1087
1088 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1089 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1090 ones might not. */
1091 t->step_count = 0;
1092
1093 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1094 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1095 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1096 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1097 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1098 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1099 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1100 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1101 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1102 tracepoint's context. */
1103 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1104 {
1105 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1106 {
1107 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1108 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1109 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1110 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1111 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1112 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1113
1114 if (while_stepping)
1115 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1116 "can be used only once"));
1117 else
1118 while_stepping = c;
1119 }
1120
1121 validate_actionline (c->line, b);
1122 }
1123 if (while_stepping)
1124 {
1125 struct command_line *c2;
1126
1127 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_list_1 == nullptr);
1128 c2 = while_stepping->body_list_0.get ();
1129 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1130 {
1131 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1132 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1133 }
1134 }
1135 }
1136 else
1137 {
1138 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1139 }
1140 }
1141
1142 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1143 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1144
1145 std::vector<breakpoint *>
1146 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1147 {
1148 struct breakpoint *b;
1149 std::vector<breakpoint *> found;
1150 struct bp_location *loc;
1151
1152 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1153 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1154 {
1155 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1156 if (loc->address == addr)
1157 found.push_back (b);
1158 }
1159
1160 return found;
1161 }
1162
1163 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1164 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1165
1166 void
1167 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1168 counted_command_line &&commands)
1169 {
1170 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands.get ());
1171
1172 b->commands = std::move (commands);
1173 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1174 }
1175
1176 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1177 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1178 commands. */
1179
1180 void
1181 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1182 {
1183 int old_silent = b->silent;
1184
1185 b->silent = silent;
1186 if (old_silent != silent)
1187 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1188 }
1189
1190 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1191 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1192
1193 void
1194 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1195 {
1196 int old_thread = b->thread;
1197
1198 b->thread = thread;
1199 if (old_thread != thread)
1200 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1201 }
1202
1203 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1204 breakpoint work for any task. */
1205
1206 void
1207 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1208 {
1209 int old_task = b->task;
1210
1211 b->task = task;
1212 if (old_task != task)
1213 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1214 }
1215
1216 static void
1217 commands_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
1218 struct command_line *control)
1219 {
1220 counted_command_line cmd;
1221 /* cmd_read will be true once we have read cmd. Note that cmd might still be
1222 NULL after the call to read_command_lines if the user provides an empty
1223 list of command by just typing "end". */
1224 bool cmd_read = false;
1225
1226 std::string new_arg;
1227
1228 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1229 {
1230 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1231 new_arg = string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1232 breakpoint_count);
1233 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1234 new_arg = string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1235 arg = new_arg.c_str ();
1236 }
1237
1238 map_breakpoint_numbers
1239 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
1240 {
1241 if (!cmd_read)
1242 {
1243 gdb_assert (cmd == NULL);
1244 if (control != NULL)
1245 cmd = control->body_list_0;
1246 else
1247 {
1248 std::string str
1249 = string_printf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1250 "%s, one per line."),
1251 arg);
1252
1253 auto do_validate = [=] (const char *line)
1254 {
1255 validate_actionline (line, b);
1256 };
1257 gdb::function_view<void (const char *)> validator;
1258 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1259 validator = do_validate;
1260
1261 cmd = read_command_lines (str.c_str (), from_tty, 1, validator);
1262 }
1263 cmd_read = true;
1264 }
1265
1266 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1267 do anything. */
1268 if (b->commands != cmd)
1269 {
1270 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, cmd.get ());
1271 b->commands = cmd;
1272 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1273 }
1274 });
1275 }
1276
1277 static void
1278 commands_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
1279 {
1280 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1281 }
1282
1283 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1284 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1285
1286 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1287 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1288 enum command_control_type
1289 commands_from_control_command (const char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1290 {
1291 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1292 return simple_control;
1293 }
1294
1295 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1296
1297 static int
1298 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1299 {
1300 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1301 return 0;
1302 if (!bl->inserted)
1303 return 0;
1304 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1305 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1306 return 0;
1307 return 1;
1308 }
1309
1310 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1311 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1312 contents.
1313
1314 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1315 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1316 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1317
1318 static void
1319 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1320 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1321 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
1322 struct bp_target_info *target_info,
1323 struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
1324 {
1325 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1326 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1327 int bp_size = 0;
1328 int bptoffset = 0;
1329
1330 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
1331 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1332 {
1333 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1334 return;
1335 }
1336
1337 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1338 we need to copy. */
1339 bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
1340 bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
1341
1342 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1343 {
1344 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1345 reading. */
1346 return;
1347 }
1348
1349 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1350 {
1351 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1352 reading. */
1353 return;
1354 }
1355
1356 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1357 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1358 {
1359 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1360 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1361 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1362 bp_addr = memaddr;
1363 }
1364
1365 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1366 {
1367 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1368 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1369 }
1370
1371 if (readbuf != NULL)
1372 {
1373 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1374 shadow_contents buffer. */
1375 gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1376 || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
1377 + target_info->shadow_len));
1378
1379 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1380 shadow. */
1381 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1382 target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1383 }
1384 else
1385 {
1386 const unsigned char *bp;
1387 CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address;
1388 int placed_size;
1389
1390 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1391 memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1392 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1393
1394 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1395 address. */
1396 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size);
1397
1398 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1399 breakpoint's INSN. */
1400 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1401 }
1402 }
1403
1404 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1405 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1406
1407 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1408 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1409 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1410
1411 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1412 bl->address - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1413 up to bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1414 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1415 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1416 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1417 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1418 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
1419 and:
1420 bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1421
1422 void
1423 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1424 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1425 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1426 {
1427 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1428 search. */
1429 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1430
1431 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1432 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1433 report higher one. */
1434
1435 bc_l = 0;
1436 bc_r = bp_locations_count;
1437 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1438 {
1439 struct bp_location *bl;
1440
1441 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1442 bl = bp_locations[bc];
1443
1444 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1445 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1446 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1447 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1448
1449 Use the BP_LOCATIONS_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1450 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1451 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1452
1453 if ((bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1454 >= bl->address)
1455 && (bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1456 <= memaddr))
1457 bc_l = bc;
1458 else
1459 bc_r = bc;
1460 }
1461
1462 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1463 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1464 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1465 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1466 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1467 B:
1468
1469 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1470
1471 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1472 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1473 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1474 and L2. */
1475 while (bc_l > 0
1476 && bp_locations[bc_l]->address == bp_locations[bc_l - 1]->address)
1477 bc_l--;
1478
1479 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1480
1481 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_locations_count; bc++)
1482 {
1483 struct bp_location *bl = bp_locations[bc];
1484
1485 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1486 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1487 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1488 bl->owner->number);
1489
1490 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1491 content. */
1492
1493 if (bl->address >= bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1494 && memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1495 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max))
1496 break;
1497
1498 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1499 continue;
1500
1501 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1502 memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
1503 }
1504 }
1505
1506 \f
1507
1508 /* Return true if BPT is either a software breakpoint or a hardware
1509 breakpoint. */
1510
1511 int
1512 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1513 {
1514 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1515 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1516 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1517 }
1518
1519 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1520
1521 static int
1522 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1523 {
1524 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1525 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1526 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1527 }
1528
1529 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1530 software. */
1531
1532 int
1533 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1534 {
1535 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1536 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1537 }
1538
1539 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1540 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1541 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1542 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1543 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1544 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1545 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1546 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1547
1548 static int
1549 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1550 {
1551 return (b->pspace == current_program_space
1552 && (b->watchpoint_thread == null_ptid
1553 || (inferior_ptid == b->watchpoint_thread
1554 && !inferior_thread ()->executing)));
1555 }
1556
1557 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1558 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1559
1560 static void
1561 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1562 {
1563 if (w->related_breakpoint != w)
1564 {
1565 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1566 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == w);
1567 w->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1568 w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w->related_breakpoint;
1569 w->related_breakpoint = w;
1570 }
1571 w->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1572 }
1573
1574 /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
1575 watchpoint W. */
1576
1577 static struct value *
1578 extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val)
1579 {
1580 struct value *bit_val;
1581
1582 if (val == NULL)
1583 return NULL;
1584
1585 bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val));
1586
1587 unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val,
1588 w->val_bitpos,
1589 w->val_bitsize,
1590 value_contents_for_printing (val),
1591 value_offset (val),
1592 val);
1593
1594 return bit_val;
1595 }
1596
1597 /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B, which must be a software
1598 watchpoint. This is required because even if a software watchpoint
1599 is not watching any memory, bpstat_stop_status requires a location
1600 to be able to report stops. */
1601
1602 static void
1603 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (struct breakpoint *b,
1604 struct program_space *pspace)
1605 {
1606 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL);
1607
1608 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1609 b->loc->pspace = pspace;
1610 b->loc->address = -1;
1611 b->loc->length = -1;
1612 }
1613
1614 /* Returns true if B is a software watchpoint that is not watching any
1615 memory (e.g., "watch $pc"). */
1616
1617 static int
1618 is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
1619 {
1620 return (b->type == bp_watchpoint
1621 && b->loc != NULL
1622 && b->loc->next == NULL
1623 && b->loc->address == -1
1624 && b->loc->length == -1);
1625 }
1626
1627 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1628 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1629 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1630 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1631 in b->loc->cond.
1632 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1633
1634 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1635 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1636 it.
1637
1638 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1639 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1640 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1641 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1642 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1643 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1644 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1645 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1646
1647 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1648 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1649 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1650 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1651 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1652 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1653 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1654 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1655 not changed.
1656
1657 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1658 hardware watchpoints:
1659
1660 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1661 called several times when GDB stops.
1662
1663 [linux]
1664 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1665 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1666 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1667 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1668 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1669 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1670 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1671 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1672 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1673 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1674 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1675
1676 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1677 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1678
1679 static void
1680 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1681 {
1682 int within_current_scope;
1683 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1684 int frame_saved;
1685
1686 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1687 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1688 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1689 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1690 return;
1691
1692 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1693 return;
1694
1695 frame_saved = 0;
1696
1697 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1698 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1699 within_current_scope = 1;
1700 else
1701 {
1702 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1703 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1704 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1705
1706 /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed
1707 (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work
1708 properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1709 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1710 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1711 return;
1712
1713 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1714 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1715 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1716 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1717 selected frame. */
1718 frame_saved = 1;
1719 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1720
1721 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1722 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1723 if (within_current_scope)
1724 select_frame (fi);
1725 }
1726
1727 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1728 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1729 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1730 b->loc = NULL;
1731
1732 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1733 {
1734 const char *s;
1735
1736 b->exp.reset ();
1737 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1738 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1739 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1740 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1741 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1742 be completely different objects. */
1743 b->val = NULL;
1744 b->val_valid = 0;
1745
1746 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1747 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1748 locations (re)created below. */
1749 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1750 {
1751 b->cond_exp.reset ();
1752
1753 s = b->cond_string;
1754 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1755 }
1756 }
1757
1758 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1759 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1760 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1761 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1762 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1763 if (!target_has_execution)
1764 {
1765 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1766 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1767 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1768 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1769 {
1770 if (b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1771 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1772 else
1773 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1774 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1775 }
1776 }
1777 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1778 {
1779 int pc = 0;
1780 std::vector<value_ref_ptr> val_chain;
1781 struct value *v, *result;
1782 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1783
1784 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain, 0);
1785
1786 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1787 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1788 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1789 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1790 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1791 watchpoints. */
1792 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (b))
1793 {
1794 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
1795 v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v);
1796 b->val = release_value (v);
1797 b->val_valid = 1;
1798 }
1799
1800 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1801
1802 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1803 gdb_assert (!val_chain.empty ());
1804 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : val_chain)
1805 {
1806 v = iter.get ();
1807
1808 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1809 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1810 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1811 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1812 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1813 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1814 && (v == val_chain[0] || ! value_lazy (v)))
1815 {
1816 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1817
1818 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1819 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1820 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1821 if (v == result
1822 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1823 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1824 {
1825 CORE_ADDR addr;
1826 enum target_hw_bp_type type;
1827 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1828 int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0;
1829
1830 if (value_bitsize (v) != 0)
1831 {
1832 /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
1833 sub-expression. */
1834 bitpos = value_bitpos (v);
1835 bitsize = value_bitsize (v);
1836 }
1837 else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0)
1838 {
1839 /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
1840 lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
1841 VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
1842 bitpos = b->val_bitpos;
1843 bitsize = b->val_bitsize;
1844 }
1845
1846 addr = value_address (v);
1847 if (bitsize != 0)
1848 {
1849 /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
1850 addr += bitpos / 8;
1851 }
1852
1853 type = hw_write;
1854 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1855 type = hw_read;
1856 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1857 type = hw_access;
1858
1859 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1860 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1861 ;
1862 *tmp = loc;
1863 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1864
1865 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1866 loc->address = address_significant (loc->gdbarch, addr);
1867
1868 if (bitsize != 0)
1869 {
1870 /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
1871 loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8;
1872 }
1873 else
1874 loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1875
1876 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1877 }
1878 }
1879 }
1880
1881 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
1882 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
1883 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
1884 is started. */
1885 if (reparse)
1886 {
1887 int reg_cnt;
1888 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
1889 struct bp_location *bl;
1890
1891 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1892
1893 if (reg_cnt)
1894 {
1895 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
1896 enum bptype type;
1897
1898 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
1899 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
1900 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
1901
1902 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
1903 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
1904 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
1905 this watchpoint in as well. */
1906
1907 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
1908 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
1909 hardware watchpoint type. */
1910 type = b->type;
1911 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
1912 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1913
1914 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
1915 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
1916 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
1917 through watch_command), so always account for it
1918 manually. */
1919
1920 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
1921 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (b, type, &other_type_used);
1922
1923 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
1924 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
1925
1926 target_resources_ok
1927 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
1928 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1929 {
1930 int sw_mode = b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b);
1931
1932 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
1933 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
1934 "hardware watchpoint."));
1935 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
1936 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
1937 "resources for this watchpoint."));
1938
1939 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
1940 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1941 }
1942 else
1943 {
1944 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
1945 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
1946 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
1947 nop. */
1948 b->type = type;
1949 }
1950 }
1951 else if (!b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1952 {
1953 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1954 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1955 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1956 else
1957 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
1958 "read/access watchpoint."));
1959 }
1960 else
1961 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1962
1963 loc_type = (b->type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
1964 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
1965 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
1966 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
1967 }
1968
1969 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
1970 above left it without any location set up. But,
1971 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
1972 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
1973 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
1974 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (b, frame_pspace);
1975 }
1976 else if (!within_current_scope)
1977 {
1978 printf_filtered (_("\
1979 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
1980 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1981 b->number);
1982 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
1983 }
1984
1985 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1986 if (frame_saved)
1987 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1988 }
1989
1990
1991 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1992 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
1993 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
1994 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
1995 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
1996 static int
1997 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
1998 {
1999 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
2000 return 0;
2001
2002 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2003 return 0;
2004
2005 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
2006 return 0;
2007
2008 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
2009 return 0;
2010
2011 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
2012 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2013 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2014 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2015 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2016 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2017 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2018 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2019 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
2020 return 0;
2021
2022 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2023 location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint,
2024 and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past
2025 a breakpoint. */
2026 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2027 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2028 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
2029 bl->address)
2030 /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location
2031 we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself.
2032 However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may
2033 break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the
2034 instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags.
2035 We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction
2036 or switch to displaced stepping. */
2037 && !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step
2038 && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread)))
2039 {
2040 if (debug_infrun)
2041 {
2042 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2043 "infrun: skipping breakpoint: "
2044 "stepping past insn at: %s\n",
2045 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2046 }
2047 return 0;
2048 }
2049
2050 /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
2051 instruction that triggered one. */
2052 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2053 && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
2054 {
2055 if (debug_infrun)
2056 {
2057 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2058 "infrun: stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
2059 "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d\n",
2060 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
2061 bl->length);
2062 }
2063 return 0;
2064 }
2065
2066 return 1;
2067 }
2068
2069 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2070 that the location is not duplicated. */
2071
2072 static int
2073 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2074 {
2075 int result;
2076 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
2077
2078 bl->duplicate = 0;
2079 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2080 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2081 return result;
2082 }
2083
2084 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2085 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2086 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2087 any error during parsing. */
2088
2089 static agent_expr_up
2090 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2091 {
2092 if (cond == NULL)
2093 return NULL;
2094
2095 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2096
2097 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2098 that may show up. */
2099 TRY
2100 {
2101 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2102 }
2103
2104 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2105 {
2106 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2107 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2108 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2109 }
2110 END_CATCH
2111
2112 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2113 return aexpr;
2114 }
2115
2116 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2117 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2118 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2119 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2120 one of them is true. */
2121
2122 static void
2123 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2124 {
2125 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2126 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2127 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2128 struct bp_location *loc;
2129
2130 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2131 bl->target_info.conditions.clear ();
2132
2133 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2134 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2135 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2136 side. */
2137 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2138 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2139 return;
2140
2141 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2142 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2143 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2144 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2145 response back to GDB. */
2146 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2147 {
2148 loc = (*loc2p);
2149 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2150 {
2151 if (modified)
2152 {
2153 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2154 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2155 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2156 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2157 loc->cond_bytecode = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2158 loc->cond.get ());
2159 }
2160
2161 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2162 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2163 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2164 {
2165 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2166 break;
2167 }
2168 }
2169 }
2170
2171 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2172 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2173 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2174
2175 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2176 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2177 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2178 {
2179 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2180 {
2181 loc = (*loc2p);
2182 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2183 {
2184 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2185 located. */
2186 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2187 return;
2188
2189 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
2190 }
2191 }
2192 }
2193
2194 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a condition list
2195 for this location's address. */
2196 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2197 {
2198 loc = (*loc2p);
2199 if (loc->cond
2200 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2201 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2202 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2203 && loc->enabled)
2204 {
2205 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later
2206 to send the conditions to the target. */
2207 bl->target_info.conditions.push_back (loc->cond_bytecode.get ());
2208 }
2209 }
2210
2211 return;
2212 }
2213
2214 /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2215 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2216 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2217
2218 static agent_expr_up
2219 parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
2220 {
2221 const char *cmdrest;
2222 const char *format_start, *format_end;
2223 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
2224
2225 if (cmd == NULL)
2226 return NULL;
2227
2228 cmdrest = cmd;
2229
2230 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2231 ++cmdrest;
2232 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2233
2234 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2235 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2236
2237 format_start = cmdrest;
2238
2239 format_pieces fpieces (&cmdrest);
2240
2241 format_end = cmdrest;
2242
2243 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2244 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2245
2246 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2247
2248 if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
2249 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2250
2251 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2252 cmdrest++;
2253 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2254
2255 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2256
2257 std::vector<struct expression *> argvec;
2258 while (*cmdrest != '\0')
2259 {
2260 const char *cmd1;
2261
2262 cmd1 = cmdrest;
2263 expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
2264 argvec.push_back (expr.release ());
2265 cmdrest = cmd1;
2266 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2267 ++cmdrest;
2268 }
2269
2270 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2271
2272 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2273 that may show up. */
2274 TRY
2275 {
2276 aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
2277 format_start, format_end - format_start,
2278 argvec.size (), argvec.data ());
2279 }
2280 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2281 {
2282 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2283 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2284 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2285 }
2286 END_CATCH
2287
2288 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2289 return aexpr;
2290 }
2291
2292 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2293 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2294 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2295
2296 static void
2297 build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2298 {
2299 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2300 int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
2301 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2302 struct bp_location *loc;
2303
2304 /* Clear commands left over from a previous insert. */
2305 bl->target_info.tcommands.clear ();
2306
2307 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2308 return;
2309
2310 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2311 if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
2312 return;
2313
2314 /* For now, if we have any duplicate location that isn't a dprintf,
2315 don't install the target-side commands, as that would make the
2316 breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2317 control. */
2318 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2319 {
2320 loc = (*loc2p);
2321 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2322 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2323 && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
2324 return;
2325 }
2326
2327 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2328 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2329 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2330 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2331 response back to GDB. */
2332 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2333 {
2334 loc = (*loc2p);
2335 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2336 {
2337 if (modified)
2338 {
2339 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2340 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2341 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2342 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2343 loc->cmd_bytecode
2344 = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2345 loc->owner->extra_string);
2346 }
2347
2348 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2349 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2350 if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
2351 {
2352 null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
2353 break;
2354 }
2355 }
2356 }
2357
2358 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2359 and so clean up. */
2360 if (null_command_or_parse_error)
2361 {
2362 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2363 {
2364 loc = (*loc2p);
2365 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2366 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2367 {
2368 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2369 located. */
2370 if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
2371 return;
2372
2373 loc->cmd_bytecode.reset ();
2374 }
2375 }
2376 }
2377
2378 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command list
2379 for this location's address. */
2380 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2381 {
2382 loc = (*loc2p);
2383 if (loc->owner->extra_string
2384 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2385 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2386 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2387 && loc->enabled)
2388 {
2389 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2390 to send the commands to the target. */
2391 bl->target_info.tcommands.push_back (loc->cmd_bytecode.get ());
2392 }
2393 }
2394
2395 bl->target_info.persist = 0;
2396 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2397 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
2398 bl->target_info.persist = 1;
2399 }
2400
2401 /* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR. Get the kind
2402 of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint.
2403 Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current
2404 registers state. */
2405
2406 static int
2407 breakpoint_kind (struct bp_location *bl, CORE_ADDR *addr)
2408 {
2409 if (bl->owner->type == bp_single_step)
2410 {
2411 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (bl->owner->thread);
2412 struct regcache *regcache;
2413
2414 regcache = get_thread_regcache (thr);
2415
2416 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl->gdbarch,
2417 regcache, addr);
2418 }
2419 else
2420 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl->gdbarch, addr);
2421 }
2422
2423 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2424 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2425 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2426 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2427 -1 for failure.
2428
2429 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2430 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2431 static int
2432 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2433 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2434 int *disabled_breaks,
2435 int *hw_breakpoint_error,
2436 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2437 {
2438 gdb_exception bp_excpt = exception_none;
2439
2440 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2441 return 0;
2442
2443 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2444 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2445 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2446 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2447 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2448 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2449 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2450 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2451 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2452 bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address;
2453 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2454 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2455
2456 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2457 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2458 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2459 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2460
2461 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2462 {
2463 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2464 build_target_command_list (bl);
2465 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2466 bl->needs_update = 0;
2467 }
2468
2469 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2470 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2471 {
2472 if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
2473 {
2474 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
2475 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
2476 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
2477
2478 Two important cases are:
2479 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
2480 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
2481 hardware breakpoint.
2482 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is
2483 read-write. This means we've previously made the
2484 location hardware one, but then the memory map changed,
2485 so we undo.
2486
2487 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
2488 location types we've just set here, the only possible
2489 problem is that memory map has changed during running
2490 program, but it's not going to work anyway with current
2491 gdb. */
2492 struct mem_region *mr
2493 = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.reqstd_address);
2494
2495 if (mr)
2496 {
2497 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2498 {
2499 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
2500
2501 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2502 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
2503 else
2504 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
2505
2506 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
2507 {
2508 static int said = 0;
2509
2510 bl->loc_type = new_type;
2511 if (!said)
2512 {
2513 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
2514 _("Note: automatically using "
2515 "hardware breakpoints for "
2516 "read-only addresses.\n"));
2517 said = 1;
2518 }
2519 }
2520 }
2521 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2522 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2523 {
2524 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2525 _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2526 "Cannot set software breakpoint "
2527 "at read-only address %s\n"),
2528 bl->owner->number,
2529 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2530 return 1;
2531 }
2532 }
2533 }
2534
2535 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2536 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2537 || bl->section == NULL
2538 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2539 {
2540 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2541 TRY
2542 {
2543 int val;
2544
2545 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2546 if (val)
2547 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2548 }
2549 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2550 {
2551 bp_excpt = e;
2552 }
2553 END_CATCH
2554 }
2555 else
2556 {
2557 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2558 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2559 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2560 {
2561 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2562 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2563 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2564 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2565 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2566 bl->owner->number);
2567 else
2568 {
2569 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2570 bl->section);
2571 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2572 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2573 bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr;
2574
2575 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2576 TRY
2577 {
2578 int val;
2579
2580 bl->overlay_target_info.kind
2581 = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
2582 bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
2583 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2584 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2585 if (val)
2586 bp_excpt
2587 = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2588 }
2589 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2590 {
2591 bp_excpt = e;
2592 }
2593 END_CATCH
2594
2595 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2596 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2597 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2598 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2599 bl->owner->number);
2600 }
2601 }
2602 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2603 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2604 {
2605 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2606 TRY
2607 {
2608 int val;
2609
2610 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2611 if (val)
2612 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2613 }
2614 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2615 {
2616 bp_excpt = e;
2617 }
2618 END_CATCH
2619 }
2620 else
2621 {
2622 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2623 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2624 return 0;
2625 }
2626 }
2627
2628 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2629 {
2630 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2631
2632 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2633 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2634 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2635 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2636 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2637 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2638 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2639 errors as memory errors. */
2640 if (bp_excpt.reason == RETURN_ERROR
2641 && (bp_excpt.error == GENERIC_ERROR
2642 || bp_excpt.error == MEMORY_ERROR)
2643 && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2644 && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
2645 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
2646 bl->address)))
2647 {
2648 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2649 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2650 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bl->owner);
2651 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2652 {
2653 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2654 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2655 bl->owner->number);
2656 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2657 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2658 "library breakpoints:\n");
2659 }
2660 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2661 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2662 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2663 return 0;
2664 }
2665 else
2666 {
2667 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2668 {
2669 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2670 *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_excpt.message != NULL;
2671 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2672 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2673 bl->owner->number,
2674 bp_excpt.message ? ":" : ".\n");
2675 if (bp_excpt.message != NULL)
2676 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n",
2677 bp_excpt.message);
2678 }
2679 else
2680 {
2681 if (bp_excpt.message == NULL)
2682 {
2683 std::string message
2684 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
2685 bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
2686
2687 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2688 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2689 "%s\n",
2690 bl->owner->number, message.c_str ());
2691 }
2692 else
2693 {
2694 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2695 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2696 bl->owner->number,
2697 bp_excpt.message);
2698 }
2699 }
2700 return 1;
2701
2702 }
2703 }
2704 else
2705 bl->inserted = 1;
2706
2707 return 0;
2708 }
2709
2710 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2711 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2712 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2713 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2714 {
2715 int val;
2716
2717 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2718 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2719
2720 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2721
2722 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2723 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2724 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2725 {
2726 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2727
2728 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2729 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2730 of this one. */
2731 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2732 if (loc != bl
2733 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2734 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2735 {
2736 bl->duplicate = 1;
2737 bl->inserted = 1;
2738 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2739 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2740 val = 0;
2741 break;
2742 }
2743
2744 if (val == 1)
2745 {
2746 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2747 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2748
2749 if (val)
2750 /* Back to the original value. */
2751 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2752 }
2753 }
2754
2755 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2756 }
2757
2758 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2759 {
2760 int val;
2761
2762 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2763 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2764
2765 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2766 if (val)
2767 {
2768 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2769
2770 if (val == 1)
2771 warning (_("\
2772 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2773 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2774 else
2775 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2776 }
2777
2778 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2779
2780 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2781 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2782 so just return success. */
2783 return 0;
2784 }
2785
2786 return 0;
2787 }
2788
2789 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2790 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2791 PSPACE anymore. */
2792
2793 void
2794 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2795 {
2796 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
2797 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2798
2799 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2800 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
2801 {
2802 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2803 delete_breakpoint (b);
2804 }
2805
2806 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2807 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2808 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2809 {
2810 struct bp_location *tmp;
2811
2812 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2813 {
2814 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2815 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2816 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
2817 else
2818 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
2819 if (tmp->next == loc)
2820 {
2821 tmp->next = loc->next;
2822 break;
2823 }
2824 }
2825 }
2826
2827 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
2828 removed locations above. */
2829 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
2830 }
2831
2832 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
2833 Throws exception on any error.
2834 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
2835 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
2836 void
2837 insert_breakpoints (void)
2838 {
2839 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2840
2841 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2842 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2843 {
2844 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
2845
2846 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
2847 }
2848
2849 /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
2850 location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
2851 ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. */
2852 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
2853 }
2854
2855 /* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location. */
2856
2857 void
2858 iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback)
2859 {
2860 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
2861
2862 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
2863 {
2864 callback (loc, NULL);
2865 }
2866 }
2867
2868 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
2869 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
2870 always-inserted mode. */
2871
2872 static void
2873 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
2874 {
2875 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2876 int error_flag = 0;
2877 int val = 0;
2878 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2879 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2880 int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
2881
2882 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2883
2884 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2885 there was an error. */
2886 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2887
2888 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2889
2890 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2891 {
2892 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
2893 breakpoints. */
2894 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2895 continue;
2896
2897 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
2898 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
2899 deletion of breakpoints. */
2900 if (!bl->inserted || !bl->needs_update)
2901 continue;
2902
2903 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2904
2905 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2906 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2907 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2908 insert breakpoints. */
2909 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2910 && inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
2911 continue;
2912
2913 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2914 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
2915 if (val)
2916 error_flag = val;
2917 }
2918
2919 if (error_flag)
2920 {
2921 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
2922 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
2923 }
2924 }
2925
2926 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
2927
2928 static void
2929 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
2930 {
2931 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2932 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2933 int error_flag = 0;
2934 int val = 0;
2935 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2936 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2937 int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
2938
2939 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2940
2941 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2942 there was an error. */
2943 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2944
2945 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2946
2947 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2948 {
2949 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2950 continue;
2951
2952 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
2953 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
2954 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2955 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
2956 && !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
2957 continue;
2958
2959 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2960
2961 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2962 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2963 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2964 insert breakpoints. */
2965 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2966 && inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
2967 continue;
2968
2969 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2970 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
2971 if (val)
2972 error_flag = val;
2973 }
2974
2975 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
2976 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
2977 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2978 {
2979 int some_failed = 0;
2980 struct bp_location *loc;
2981
2982 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2983 continue;
2984
2985 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2986 continue;
2987
2988 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2989 continue;
2990
2991 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2992 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
2993 {
2994 some_failed = 1;
2995 break;
2996 }
2997 if (some_failed)
2998 {
2999 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3000 if (loc->inserted)
3001 remove_breakpoint (loc);
3002
3003 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
3004 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert "
3005 "hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
3006 bpt->number);
3007 error_flag = -1;
3008 }
3009 }
3010
3011 if (error_flag)
3012 {
3013 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
3014 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
3015 if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
3016 {
3017 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
3018 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
3019 }
3020 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
3021 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3022 }
3023 }
3024
3025 /* Used when the program stops.
3026 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
3027 removing a breakpoint location. */
3028
3029 int
3030 remove_breakpoints (void)
3031 {
3032 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3033 int val = 0;
3034
3035 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3036 {
3037 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
3038 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl);
3039 }
3040 return val;
3041 }
3042
3043 /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3044 that thread. */
3045
3046 static void
3047 remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
3048 {
3049 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3050
3051 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3052 {
3053 if (b->thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
3054 {
3055 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3056
3057 printf_filtered (_("\
3058 Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3059 b->number, print_thread_id (tp));
3060
3061 /* Hide it from the user. */
3062 b->number = 0;
3063 }
3064 }
3065 }
3066
3067 /* Remove breakpoints of inferior INF. */
3068
3069 int
3070 remove_breakpoints_inf (inferior *inf)
3071 {
3072 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3073 int val;
3074
3075 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3076 {
3077 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3078 continue;
3079
3080 if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist)
3081 {
3082 val = remove_breakpoint (bl);
3083 if (val != 0)
3084 return val;
3085 }
3086 }
3087 return 0;
3088 }
3089
3090 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
3091
3092 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3093 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3094 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3095 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3096 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3097 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3098 static void
3099 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
3100 {
3101 if (internal)
3102 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3103 else
3104 {
3105 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
3106 b->number = breakpoint_count;
3107 }
3108 }
3109
3110 static struct breakpoint *
3111 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
3112 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
3113 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
3114 {
3115 symtab_and_line sal;
3116 sal.pc = address;
3117 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
3118 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
3119
3120 breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
3121 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3122 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
3123
3124 return b;
3125 }
3126
3127 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
3128 {
3129 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3130 };
3131 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3132
3133 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3134 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3135 {
3136 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3137 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym {};
3138
3139 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3140 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES] {};
3141
3142 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3143 int longjmp_searched = 0;
3144
3145 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). These are non-owning
3146 references. */
3147 std::vector<probe *> longjmp_probes;
3148
3149 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3150 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym {};
3151
3152 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3153 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym {};
3154
3155 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3156 int exception_searched = 0;
3157
3158 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). These are non-owning
3159 references. */
3160 std::vector<probe *> exception_probes;
3161 };
3162
3163 static const struct objfile_data *breakpoint_objfile_key;
3164
3165 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3166 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
3167
3168 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3169
3170 static int
3171 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
3172 {
3173 return msym == &msym_not_found;
3174 }
3175
3176 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3177 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3178
3179 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
3180 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
3181 {
3182 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3183
3184 bp_objfile_data = ((struct breakpoint_objfile_data *)
3185 objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key));
3186 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
3187 {
3188 bp_objfile_data = new breakpoint_objfile_data ();
3189 set_objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key, bp_objfile_data);
3190 }
3191 return bp_objfile_data;
3192 }
3193
3194 static void
3195 free_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *obj, void *data)
3196 {
3197 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data
3198 = (struct breakpoint_objfile_data *) data;
3199
3200 delete bp_objfile_data;
3201 }
3202
3203 static void
3204 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3205 {
3206 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
3207
3208 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3209 {
3210 struct breakpoint *b;
3211 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3212 CORE_ADDR addr;
3213 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3214
3215 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3216
3217 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
3218 continue;
3219
3220 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
3221 {
3222 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3223
3224 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3225 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3226 {
3227 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3228 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3229 continue;
3230 }
3231 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
3232 }
3233
3234 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
3235 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3236 bp_overlay_event,
3237 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3238 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3239 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3240 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3241
3242 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
3243 {
3244 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
3245 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
3246 }
3247 else
3248 {
3249 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3250 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
3251 }
3252 }
3253 }
3254
3255 static void
3256 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3257 {
3258 struct program_space *pspace;
3259
3260 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3261
3262 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3263 {
3264 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3265
3266 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3267 {
3268 int i;
3269 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3270 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3271
3272 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3273
3274 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3275
3276 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
3277 {
3278 std::vector<probe *> ret
3279 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
3280
3281 if (!ret.empty ())
3282 {
3283 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3284 probe *p = ret[0];
3285
3286 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3287 {
3288 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3289 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3290 ret.clear ();
3291 }
3292 }
3293 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
3294 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
3295 }
3296
3297 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes.empty ())
3298 {
3299 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes)
3300 {
3301 struct breakpoint *b;
3302
3303 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3304 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3305 bp_longjmp_master,
3306 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3307 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3308 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3309 }
3310
3311 continue;
3312 }
3313
3314 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
3315 continue;
3316
3317 for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
3318 {
3319 struct breakpoint *b;
3320 const char *func_name;
3321 CORE_ADDR addr;
3322 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3323
3324 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
3325 continue;
3326
3327 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
3328 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
3329 {
3330 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3331
3332 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3333 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3334 {
3335 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3336 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
3337 continue;
3338 }
3339 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3340 }
3341
3342 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
3343 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3344 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3345 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3346 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3347 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3348 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3349 }
3350 }
3351 }
3352 }
3353
3354 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3355 static void
3356 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3357 {
3358 struct program_space *pspace;
3359 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3360
3361 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3362
3363 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3364 {
3365 CORE_ADDR addr;
3366
3367 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3368
3369 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3370 {
3371 struct breakpoint *b;
3372 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3373 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3374
3375 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3376
3377 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
3378 continue;
3379
3380 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
3381 {
3382 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3383
3384 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3385 if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text
3386 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text))
3387 {
3388 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3389 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3390 continue;
3391 }
3392 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3393 }
3394
3395 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
3396 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3397 bp_std_terminate_master,
3398 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3399 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3400 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3401 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3402 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3403 }
3404 }
3405 }
3406
3407 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3408
3409 static void
3410 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3411 {
3412 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3413
3414 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3415 {
3416 struct breakpoint *b;
3417 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3418 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3419 CORE_ADDR addr;
3420 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3421
3422 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3423
3424 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3425 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3426 {
3427 std::vector<probe *> ret
3428 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3429
3430 if (!ret.empty ())
3431 {
3432 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3433 probe *p = ret[0];
3434
3435 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3436 {
3437 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3438 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3439 ret.clear ();
3440 }
3441 }
3442 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
3443 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3444 }
3445
3446 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_probes.empty ())
3447 {
3448 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3449
3450 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->exception_probes)
3451 {
3452 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3453 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3454 bp_exception_master,
3455 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3456 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3457 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3458 }
3459
3460 continue;
3461 }
3462
3463 /* Otherwise, try the hook function. */
3464
3465 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
3466 continue;
3467
3468 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3469
3470 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
3471 {
3472 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
3473
3474 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3475 if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
3476 {
3477 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3478 continue;
3479 }
3480
3481 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3482 }
3483
3484 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
3485 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
3486 current_top_target ());
3487 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3488 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3489 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3490 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3491 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3492 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3493 }
3494 }
3495
3496 /* Does B have a location spec? */
3497
3498 static int
3499 breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b)
3500 {
3501 return b->location != NULL && event_location_empty_p (b->location.get ());
3502 }
3503
3504 void
3505 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3506 {
3507 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3508 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
3509
3510 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3511 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3512 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3513 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3514 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3515 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3516 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3517 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3518 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
3519 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3520 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3521
3522 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3523 {
3524 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3525 continue;
3526
3527 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3528 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3529 {
3530 delete_breakpoint (b);
3531 continue;
3532 }
3533
3534 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3535 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3536 {
3537 delete_breakpoint (b);
3538 continue;
3539 }
3540
3541 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3542 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3543 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3544 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3545 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3546 {
3547 delete_breakpoint (b);
3548 continue;
3549 }
3550
3551 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3552 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3553 {
3554 delete_breakpoint (b);
3555 continue;
3556 }
3557
3558 /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
3559 if (b->type == bp_single_step)
3560 {
3561 delete_breakpoint (b);
3562 continue;
3563 }
3564
3565 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3566 after an exec. */
3567 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3568 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3569 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3570 {
3571 delete_breakpoint (b);
3572 continue;
3573 }
3574
3575 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3576 {
3577 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3578 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3579 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3580 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3581 continue;
3582 }
3583
3584 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3585 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3586 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3587 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3588 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3589 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3590
3591 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3592 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3593 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3594 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3595 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3596 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3597 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3598
3599 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3600 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3601 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3602 let finish_command delete it.
3603
3604 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3605 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3606 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3607 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3608 solib breakpoints.) */
3609
3610 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3611 {
3612 continue;
3613 }
3614
3615 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3616 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3617 a.out. */
3618 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
3619 {
3620 delete_breakpoint (b);
3621 continue;
3622 }
3623 }
3624 }
3625
3626 int
3627 detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
3628 {
3629 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3630 int val = 0;
3631 scoped_restore save_inferior_ptid = make_scoped_restore (&inferior_ptid);
3632 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3633
3634 if (ptid.pid () == inferior_ptid.pid ())
3635 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3636
3637 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3638 inferior_ptid = ptid;
3639 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3640 {
3641 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3642 continue;
3643
3644 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3645 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3646 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3647 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3648 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3649 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3650 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
3651 continue;
3652
3653 if (bl->inserted)
3654 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3655 }
3656
3657 return val;
3658 }
3659
3660 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3661 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3662 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3663 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3664 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3665
3666 static int
3667 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
3668 {
3669 int val;
3670
3671 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3672 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3673
3674 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3675 This should not ever happen. */
3676 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3677
3678 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3679 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3680 {
3681 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3682 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3683 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3684
3685 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3686 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3687 || bl->section == NULL
3688 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3689 {
3690 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3691
3692 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3693 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3694 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3695 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3696 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3697 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3698 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3699 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3700 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3701 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3702 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3703 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3704 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3705 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3706 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3707 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3708 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3709 they should always be removed. */
3710 if (bl->shlib_disabled
3711 && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
3712 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
3713 val = 0;
3714 else
3715 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3716 }
3717 else
3718 {
3719 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3720 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3721 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3722 {
3723 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3724 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3725 */
3726 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
3727 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
3728 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3729 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3730 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3731 else
3732 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3733 &bl->overlay_target_info,
3734 reason);
3735 }
3736 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
3737 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
3738 if (bl->inserted)
3739 {
3740 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
3741 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
3742 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
3743 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
3744
3745 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
3746 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
3747 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
3748 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
3749 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3750 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3751 else
3752 val = 0;
3753 }
3754 else
3755 {
3756 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
3757 val = 0;
3758 }
3759 }
3760
3761 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
3762 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
3763 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
3764 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
3765 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
3766 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
3767 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
3768 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
3769 always-inserted mode. */
3770 if (val
3771 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3772 && (bl->shlib_disabled
3773 || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
3774 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
3775 bl->address))))
3776 val = 0;
3777
3778 if (val)
3779 return val;
3780 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3781 }
3782 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
3783 {
3784 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3785 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3786
3787 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3788 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3789
3790 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
3791 if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted)
3792 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
3793 bl->owner->number);
3794 }
3795 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
3796 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3797 && !bl->duplicate)
3798 {
3799 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3800 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3801
3802 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3803 if (val)
3804 return val;
3805
3806 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3807 }
3808
3809 return 0;
3810 }
3811
3812 static int
3813 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
3814 {
3815 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3816 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3817
3818 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3819 This should not ever happen. */
3820 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3821
3822 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
3823
3824 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3825
3826 return remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT);
3827 }
3828
3829 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
3830
3831 void
3832 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
3833 {
3834 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3835
3836 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3837 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
3838 bl->inserted = 0;
3839 }
3840
3841 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
3842 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
3843
3844 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
3845 between runs.
3846
3847 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
3848 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
3849 init_wait_for_inferior). */
3850
3851
3852
3853 void
3854 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
3855 {
3856 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3857 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
3858
3859 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
3860 nothing to do. */
3861 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
3862 return;
3863
3864 mark_breakpoints_out ();
3865
3866 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3867 {
3868 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
3869 continue;
3870
3871 switch (b->type)
3872 {
3873 case bp_call_dummy:
3874 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
3875
3876 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
3877 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
3878 rid of it. */
3879
3880 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3881
3882 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
3883
3884 case bp_shlib_event:
3885
3886 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
3887 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
3888 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
3889 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
3890 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
3891
3892 (gdb) file prog-linux
3893 (gdb) run # native linux target
3894 ...
3895 (gdb) kill
3896 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
3897 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
3898 */
3899
3900 case bp_step_resume:
3901
3902 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
3903
3904 case bp_single_step:
3905
3906 /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
3907
3908 delete_breakpoint (b);
3909 break;
3910
3911 case bp_watchpoint:
3912 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3913 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3914 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3915 {
3916 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
3917
3918 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
3919 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
3920 delete_breakpoint (b);
3921 else
3922 {
3923 /* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer
3924 valid. New ones will be created in
3925 update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted.
3926 The next update_global_location_list call will
3927 garbage collect them. */
3928 b->loc = NULL;
3929
3930 if (context == inf_starting)
3931 {
3932 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
3933 insert_breakpoints. */
3934 w->val.reset (nullptr);
3935 w->val_valid = 0;
3936 }
3937 }
3938 }
3939 break;
3940 default:
3941 break;
3942 }
3943 }
3944
3945 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
3946 for (bp_location *bl : moribund_locations)
3947 decref_bp_location (&bl);
3948 moribund_locations.clear ();
3949 }
3950
3951 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
3952 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
3953 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
3954 match, not program space. */
3955
3956 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
3957 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
3958 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
3959 permanent breakpoint.
3960 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
3961 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
3962 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
3963 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
3964 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
3965
3966 enum breakpoint_here
3967 breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
3968 {
3969 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3970 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
3971
3972 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3973 {
3974 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3975 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3976 continue;
3977
3978 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3979 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3980 || bl->permanent)
3981 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
3982 {
3983 if (overlay_debugging
3984 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3985 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3986 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
3987 else if (bl->permanent)
3988 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
3989 else
3990 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
3991 }
3992 }
3993
3994 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here;
3995 }
3996
3997 /* See breakpoint.h. */
3998
3999 int
4000 breakpoint_in_range_p (const address_space *aspace,
4001 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4002 {
4003 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4004
4005 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4006 {
4007 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4008 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4009 continue;
4010
4011 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4012 || bl->permanent)
4013 && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace,
4014 addr, len))
4015 {
4016 if (overlay_debugging
4017 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4018 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4019 {
4020 /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match. */
4021 continue;
4022 }
4023
4024 return 1;
4025 }
4026 }
4027
4028 return 0;
4029 }
4030
4031 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
4032
4033 int
4034 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4035 {
4036 for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
4037 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
4038 return 1;
4039
4040 return 0;
4041 }
4042
4043 /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space
4044 ASPACE. */
4045
4046 static int
4047 bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl,
4048 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4049 {
4050 if (bl->inserted
4051 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
4052 aspace, pc))
4053 {
4054 if (overlay_debugging
4055 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4056 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4057 return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4058 else
4059 return 1;
4060 }
4061 return 0;
4062 }
4063
4064 /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4065
4066 int
4067 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4068 {
4069 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4070
4071 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4072 {
4073 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4074
4075 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4076 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4077 continue;
4078
4079 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4080 return 1;
4081 }
4082 return 0;
4083 }
4084
4085 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4086 inserted at PC. */
4087
4088 int
4089 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4090 CORE_ADDR pc)
4091 {
4092 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4093
4094 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4095 {
4096 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4097
4098 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
4099 continue;
4100
4101 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4102 return 1;
4103 }
4104
4105 return 0;
4106 }
4107
4108 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4109
4110 int
4111 hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4112 CORE_ADDR pc)
4113 {
4114 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4115
4116 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4117 {
4118 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4119
4120 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4121 continue;
4122
4123 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4124 return 1;
4125 }
4126
4127 return 0;
4128 }
4129
4130 int
4131 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (const address_space *aspace,
4132 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4133 {
4134 struct breakpoint *bpt;
4135
4136 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
4137 {
4138 struct bp_location *loc;
4139
4140 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
4141 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
4142 continue;
4143
4144 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
4145 continue;
4146
4147 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4148 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
4149 {
4150 CORE_ADDR l, h;
4151
4152 /* Check for intersection. */
4153 l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address, addr);
4154 h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
4155 if (l < h)
4156 return 1;
4157 }
4158 }
4159 return 0;
4160 }
4161 \f
4162
4163 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
4164 in breakpoint.h. */
4165
4166 int
4167 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
4168 {
4169 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
4170 }
4171
4172 /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
4173 'next' chain. */
4174
4175 bpstats::~bpstats ()
4176 {
4177 if (bp_location_at != NULL)
4178 decref_bp_location (&bp_location_at);
4179 }
4180
4181 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4182 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4183
4184 void
4185 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
4186 {
4187 bpstat p;
4188 bpstat q;
4189
4190 if (bsp == 0)
4191 return;
4192 p = *bsp;
4193 while (p != NULL)
4194 {
4195 q = p->next;
4196 delete p;
4197 p = q;
4198 }
4199 *bsp = NULL;
4200 }
4201
4202 bpstats::bpstats (const bpstats &other)
4203 : next (NULL),
4204 bp_location_at (other.bp_location_at),
4205 breakpoint_at (other.breakpoint_at),
4206 commands (other.commands),
4207 print (other.print),
4208 stop (other.stop),
4209 print_it (other.print_it)
4210 {
4211 if (other.old_val != NULL)
4212 old_val = release_value (value_copy (other.old_val.get ()));
4213 incref_bp_location (bp_location_at);
4214 }
4215
4216 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4217 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4218
4219 bpstat
4220 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
4221 {
4222 bpstat p = NULL;
4223 bpstat tmp;
4224 bpstat retval = NULL;
4225
4226 if (bs == NULL)
4227 return bs;
4228
4229 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4230 {
4231 tmp = new bpstats (*bs);
4232
4233 if (p == NULL)
4234 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4235 retval = tmp;
4236 else
4237 p->next = tmp;
4238 p = tmp;
4239 }
4240 p->next = NULL;
4241 return retval;
4242 }
4243
4244 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4245
4246 bpstat
4247 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
4248 {
4249 if (bsp == NULL)
4250 return NULL;
4251
4252 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4253 {
4254 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
4255 return bsp;
4256 }
4257 return NULL;
4258 }
4259
4260 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4261
4262 int
4263 bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
4264 {
4265 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4266 {
4267 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4268 {
4269 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4270 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
4271 if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
4272 return 1;
4273 }
4274 else
4275 {
4276 if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
4277 sig))
4278 return 1;
4279 }
4280 }
4281
4282 return 0;
4283 }
4284
4285 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4286 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4287 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4288 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4289
4290 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4291 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4292 we set it.
4293 Return 1 otherwise. */
4294
4295 int
4296 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
4297 {
4298 struct breakpoint *b;
4299
4300 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
4301 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4302
4303 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4304 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4305 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4306 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
4307 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
4308 if (b == NULL)
4309 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4310
4311 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
4312 return 1;
4313 }
4314
4315 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4316
4317 void
4318 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4319 {
4320 bpstat bs;
4321
4322 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
4323 return;
4324
4325 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4326 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4327 {
4328 bs->commands = NULL;
4329 bs->old_val.reset (nullptr);
4330 }
4331 }
4332
4333 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4334
4335 static void
4336 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4337 {
4338 if (inferior_ptid != null_ptid)
4339 {
4340 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4341
4342 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4343 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4344 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4345 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4346 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
4347 return;
4348 }
4349
4350 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
4351 }
4352
4353 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4354 or its equivalent. */
4355
4356 static int
4357 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
4358 {
4359 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0);
4360 }
4361
4362 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4363 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4364 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4365 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4366
4367 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4368 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4369 bpstat of the current thread. */
4370
4371 static int
4372 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
4373 {
4374 bpstat bs;
4375 int again = 0;
4376
4377 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4378 in bs->commands. */
4379 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4380 return 0;
4381
4382 scoped_restore save_executing
4383 = make_scoped_restore (&executing_breakpoint_commands, 1);
4384
4385 scoped_restore preventer = prevent_dont_repeat ();
4386
4387 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4388 bs = *bsp;
4389
4390 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4391 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4392 {
4393 struct command_line *cmd = NULL;
4394
4395 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4396
4397 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4398 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4399 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4400 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4401 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4402 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4403 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4404 the tree when we're done. */
4405 counted_command_line ccmd = bs->commands;
4406 bs->commands = NULL;
4407 if (ccmd != NULL)
4408 cmd = ccmd.get ();
4409 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4410 {
4411 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4412 cmd = cmd->next;
4413 }
4414
4415 while (cmd != NULL)
4416 {
4417 execute_control_command (cmd);
4418
4419 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4420 break;
4421 else
4422 cmd = cmd->next;
4423 }
4424
4425 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4426 {
4427 if (current_ui->async)
4428 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4429 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4430 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4431 ;
4432 else
4433 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4434 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4435 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4436 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4437 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4438 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4439 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4440 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4441 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4442 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4443 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4444 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4445 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4446 again = 1;
4447 break;
4448 }
4449 }
4450 return again;
4451 }
4452
4453 /* Helper for bpstat_do_actions. Get the current thread, if there's
4454 one, is alive and has execution. Return NULL otherwise. */
4455
4456 static thread_info *
4457 get_bpstat_thread ()
4458 {
4459 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution)
4460 return NULL;
4461
4462 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4463 if (tp->state == THREAD_EXITED || tp->executing)
4464 return NULL;
4465 return tp;
4466 }
4467
4468 void
4469 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4470 {
4471 auto cleanup_if_error = make_scope_exit (bpstat_clear_actions);
4472 thread_info *tp;
4473
4474 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4475 while ((tp = get_bpstat_thread ()) != NULL)
4476 {
4477 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the
4478 inferior, and only return when it is stopped at the next
4479 breakpoint, we keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns
4480 false to indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4481 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tp->control.stop_bpstat))
4482 break;
4483 }
4484
4485 cleanup_if_error.release ();
4486 }
4487
4488 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4489
4490 static void
4491 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4492 {
4493 if (val == NULL)
4494 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
4495 else
4496 {
4497 struct value_print_options opts;
4498 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4499 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4500 }
4501 }
4502
4503 /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if
4504 debugging multiple threads. */
4505
4506 void
4507 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout)
4508 {
4509 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4510 return;
4511
4512 uiout->text ("\n");
4513
4514 if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ())
4515 {
4516 const char *name;
4517 struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread ();
4518
4519 uiout->text ("Thread ");
4520 uiout->field_fmt ("thread-id", "%s", print_thread_id (thr));
4521
4522 name = thr->name != NULL ? thr->name : target_thread_name (thr);
4523 if (name != NULL)
4524 {
4525 uiout->text (" \"");
4526 uiout->field_fmt ("name", "%s", name);
4527 uiout->text ("\"");
4528 }
4529
4530 uiout->text (" hit ");
4531 }
4532 }
4533
4534 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4535 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4536 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4537 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4538 normal_stop(). */
4539
4540 static enum print_stop_action
4541 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
4542 {
4543 switch (bs->print_it)
4544 {
4545 case print_it_noop:
4546 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4547 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4548 break;
4549
4550 case print_it_done:
4551 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4552 relevant messages. */
4553 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4554 break;
4555
4556 case print_it_normal:
4557 {
4558 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4559
4560 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4561 which has since been deleted. */
4562 if (b == NULL)
4563 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4564
4565 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4566 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4567 }
4568 break;
4569
4570 default:
4571 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4572 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4573 break;
4574 }
4575 }
4576
4577 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4578
4579 static void
4580 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4581 {
4582 bool any_deleted = !current_program_space->deleted_solibs.empty ();
4583 bool any_added = !current_program_space->added_solibs.empty ();
4584
4585 if (!is_catchpoint)
4586 {
4587 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4588 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4589 else
4590 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4591 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4592 }
4593
4594 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4595 current_uiout->field_string ("reason",
4596 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4597
4598 if (any_deleted)
4599 {
4600 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior unloaded "));
4601 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "removed");
4602 for (int ix = 0; ix < current_program_space->deleted_solibs.size (); ix++)
4603 {
4604 const std::string &name = current_program_space->deleted_solibs[ix];
4605
4606 if (ix > 0)
4607 current_uiout->text (" ");
4608 current_uiout->field_string ("library", name);
4609 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4610 }
4611 }
4612
4613 if (any_added)
4614 {
4615 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior loaded "));
4616 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "added");
4617 bool first = true;
4618 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
4619 {
4620 if (!first)
4621 current_uiout->text (" ");
4622 first = false;
4623 current_uiout->field_string ("library", iter->so_name);
4624 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4625 }
4626 }
4627 }
4628
4629 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4630 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4631 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4632 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4633 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4634 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4635 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4636 routine is one of:
4637
4638 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4639 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4640 code to print the location. An example is
4641 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4642 the location.
4643 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4644 to also print the location part of the message.
4645 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4646 don't require a location appended to the end.
4647 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4648 further info to be printed. */
4649
4650 enum print_stop_action
4651 bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
4652 {
4653 enum print_stop_action val;
4654
4655 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4656 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4657 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4658 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4659 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4660 {
4661 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4662 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4663 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4664 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4665 return val;
4666 }
4667
4668 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4669 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4670 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4671 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4672 {
4673 print_solib_event (0);
4674 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4675 }
4676
4677 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4678 with and nothing was printed. */
4679 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4680 }
4681
4682 /* Evaluate the boolean expression EXP and return the result. */
4683
4684 static bool
4685 breakpoint_cond_eval (expression *exp)
4686 {
4687 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4688 bool res = value_true (evaluate_expression (exp));
4689
4690 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4691 return res;
4692 }
4693
4694 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
4695
4696 bpstats::bpstats (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
4697 : next (NULL),
4698 bp_location_at (bl),
4699 breakpoint_at (bl->owner),
4700 commands (NULL),
4701 print (0),
4702 stop (0),
4703 print_it (print_it_normal)
4704 {
4705 incref_bp_location (bl);
4706 **bs_link_pointer = this;
4707 *bs_link_pointer = &next;
4708 }
4709
4710 bpstats::bpstats ()
4711 : next (NULL),
4712 bp_location_at (NULL),
4713 breakpoint_at (NULL),
4714 commands (NULL),
4715 print (0),
4716 stop (0),
4717 print_it (print_it_normal)
4718 {
4719 }
4720 \f
4721 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
4722 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
4723
4724 int
4725 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4726 {
4727 bool stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
4728 CORE_ADDR addr;
4729 struct breakpoint *b;
4730
4731 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
4732 {
4733 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
4734 as not triggered. */
4735 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4736 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4737 {
4738 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4739
4740 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4741 }
4742
4743 return 0;
4744 }
4745
4746 if (!target_stopped_data_address (current_top_target (), &addr))
4747 {
4748 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
4749 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
4750 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4751 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4752 {
4753 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4754
4755 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
4756 }
4757
4758 return 1;
4759 }
4760
4761 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
4762 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
4763 triggered. */
4764
4765 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4766 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4767 {
4768 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4769 struct bp_location *loc;
4770
4771 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4772 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4773 {
4774 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4775 {
4776 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
4777 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
4778
4779 if (newaddr == start)
4780 {
4781 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4782 break;
4783 }
4784 }
4785 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
4786 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (current_top_target (),
4787 addr, loc->address,
4788 loc->length))
4789 {
4790 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4791 break;
4792 }
4793 }
4794 }
4795
4796 return 1;
4797 }
4798
4799 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check. */
4800 enum wp_check_result
4801 {
4802 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
4803 WP_DELETED = 1,
4804
4805 /* The value has changed. */
4806 WP_VALUE_CHANGED = 2,
4807
4808 /* The value has not changed. */
4809 WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED = 3,
4810
4811 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
4812 WP_IGNORE = 4,
4813 };
4814
4815 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
4816 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
4817
4818 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
4819 changed. */
4820
4821 static wp_check_result
4822 watchpoint_check (bpstat bs)
4823 {
4824 struct watchpoint *b;
4825 struct frame_info *fr;
4826 int within_current_scope;
4827
4828 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
4829 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
4830 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4831
4832 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
4833 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
4834 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
4835 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
4836 return WP_IGNORE;
4837
4838 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
4839 within_current_scope = 1;
4840 else
4841 {
4842 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
4843 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
4844 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
4845
4846 /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
4847 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
4848 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
4849 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
4850 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
4851 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
4852 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
4853 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
4854 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
4855 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
4856 return WP_IGNORE;
4857
4858 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
4859 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
4860
4861 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
4862 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
4863 if (within_current_scope)
4864 {
4865 struct symbol *function;
4866
4867 function = get_frame_function (fr);
4868 if (function == NULL
4869 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
4870 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
4871 within_current_scope = 0;
4872 }
4873
4874 if (within_current_scope)
4875 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
4876 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
4877 the user. */
4878 select_frame (fr);
4879 }
4880
4881 if (within_current_scope)
4882 {
4883 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
4884 time before we return to the command level and call
4885 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
4886 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
4887
4888 int pc = 0;
4889 struct value *mark;
4890 struct value *new_val;
4891
4892 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4893 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
4894 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
4895 a mask watchpoint. */
4896 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4897
4898 mark = value_mark ();
4899 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL, 0);
4900
4901 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
4902 new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val);
4903
4904 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
4905 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
4906 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
4907 not what we want. */
4908 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
4909 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val.get (),
4910 new_val)))
4911 {
4912 bs->old_val = b->val;
4913 b->val = release_value (new_val);
4914 b->val_valid = 1;
4915 if (new_val != NULL)
4916 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4917 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4918 }
4919 else
4920 {
4921 /* Nothing changed. */
4922 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4923 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
4924 }
4925 }
4926 else
4927 {
4928 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
4929 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
4930 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
4931 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
4932 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
4933 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
4934 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
4935 the first value assigned). */
4936 /* We print all the stop information in
4937 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
4938 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
4939 already. So we have no choice but print the information
4940 here. */
4941
4942 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
4943 {
4944 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
4945
4946 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4947 uiout->field_string
4948 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
4949 uiout->text ("\nWatchpoint ");
4950 uiout->field_int ("wpnum", b->number);
4951 uiout->text (" deleted because the program has left the block in\n"
4952 "which its expression is valid.\n");
4953 }
4954
4955 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
4956 b->commands = NULL;
4957 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
4958
4959 return WP_DELETED;
4960 }
4961 }
4962
4963 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
4964 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
4965 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
4966
4967 static int
4968 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
4969 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
4970 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4971 {
4972 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
4973
4974 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
4975 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
4976
4977 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
4978 }
4979
4980 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
4981 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
4982
4983 static void
4984 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
4985 {
4986 const struct bp_location *bl;
4987 struct watchpoint *b;
4988
4989 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
4990 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
4991 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
4992 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4993 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
4994
4995 {
4996 int must_check_value = 0;
4997
4998 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
4999 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
5000 watched value. */
5001 must_check_value = 1;
5002 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
5003 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
5004 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
5005 this watchpoint. */
5006 must_check_value = 1;
5007 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
5008 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5009 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
5010 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
5011 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
5012 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
5013 must_check_value = 1;
5014
5015 if (must_check_value)
5016 {
5017 wp_check_result e;
5018
5019 TRY
5020 {
5021 e = watchpoint_check (bs);
5022 }
5023 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
5024 {
5025 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5026 "Error evaluating expression "
5027 "for watchpoint %d\n",
5028 b->number);
5029
5030 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
5031 {
5032 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"),
5033 b->number);
5034 }
5035 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5036 e = WP_DELETED;
5037 }
5038 END_CATCH
5039
5040 switch (e)
5041 {
5042 case WP_DELETED:
5043 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5044 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5045 /* Stop. */
5046 break;
5047 case WP_IGNORE:
5048 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5049 bs->stop = 0;
5050 break;
5051 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
5052 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5053 {
5054 /* There are two cases to consider here:
5055
5056 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5057 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5058 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5059 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5060 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5061 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5062 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5063 old value.
5064
5065 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5066 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5067 happen:
5068
5069 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5070 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5071 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5072 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5073
5074 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5075 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5076 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5077 watchpoint.
5078
5079 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5080 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5081 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5082 changes. This still gives false positives when
5083 the program writes the same value to memory as
5084 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5085 it for a read), but it's much better than
5086 nothing. */
5087
5088 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
5089
5090 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
5091 {
5092 struct breakpoint *other_b;
5093
5094 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
5095 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5096 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
5097 {
5098 struct watchpoint *other_w =
5099 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
5100
5101 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
5102 == watch_triggered_yes)
5103 {
5104 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
5105 break;
5106 }
5107 }
5108 }
5109
5110 if (other_write_watchpoint
5111 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
5112 {
5113 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5114 and the value changed since the last time we
5115 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5116 Ignore it. */
5117 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5118 bs->stop = 0;
5119 }
5120 }
5121 break;
5122 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
5123 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5124 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5125 {
5126 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5127 the value hasn't changed. */
5128 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5129 bs->stop = 0;
5130 }
5131 /* Stop. */
5132 break;
5133 default:
5134 /* Can't happen. */
5135 break;
5136 }
5137 }
5138 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5139 {
5140 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5141 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5142 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5143 anything for this watchpoint. */
5144 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5145 bs->stop = 0;
5146 }
5147 }
5148 }
5149
5150 /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5151 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5152 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5153 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5154
5155 static void
5156 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, thread_info *thread)
5157 {
5158 const struct bp_location *bl;
5159 struct breakpoint *b;
5160 /* Assume stop. */
5161 bool condition_result = true;
5162 struct expression *cond;
5163
5164 gdb_assert (bs->stop);
5165
5166 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5167 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5168 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5169 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5170 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5171
5172 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5173 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5174 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5175
5176 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
5177 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5178 {
5179 bs->stop = 0;
5180 return;
5181 }
5182
5183 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5184 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5185 thread/task. */
5186 if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread->global_num)
5187 || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (thread)))
5188 {
5189 bs->stop = 0;
5190 return;
5191 }
5192
5193 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5194 implemented. */
5195 bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
5196
5197 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5198 {
5199 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5200
5201 cond = w->cond_exp.get ();
5202 }
5203 else
5204 cond = bl->cond.get ();
5205
5206 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
5207 {
5208 int within_current_scope = 1;
5209 struct watchpoint * w;
5210
5211 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5212 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5213 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5214 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5215 function call. */
5216 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5217
5218 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5219 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5220 else
5221 w = NULL;
5222
5223 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5224 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5225 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5226 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5227 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5228 call site. */
5229 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
5230 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5231 else
5232 {
5233 struct frame_info *frame;
5234
5235 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5236 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5237 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5238 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5239 really matter which instantiation of the function
5240 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5241 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5242 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5243 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5244 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5245 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5246 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5247 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5248 intuitive. */
5249 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
5250 if (frame != NULL)
5251 select_frame (frame);
5252 else
5253 within_current_scope = 0;
5254 }
5255 if (within_current_scope)
5256 {
5257 TRY
5258 {
5259 condition_result = breakpoint_cond_eval (cond);
5260 }
5261 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
5262 {
5263 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5264 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n");
5265 }
5266 END_CATCH
5267 }
5268 else
5269 {
5270 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5271 "in the current scope"));
5272 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5273 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5274 }
5275 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5276 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5277 }
5278
5279 if (cond && !condition_result)
5280 {
5281 bs->stop = 0;
5282 }
5283 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
5284 {
5285 b->ignore_count--;
5286 bs->stop = 0;
5287 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5288 ++(b->hit_count);
5289 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5290 }
5291 }
5292
5293 /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type
5294 on the current target. */
5295
5296 static int
5297 need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc)
5298 {
5299 return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
5300 && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ())
5301 || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5302 && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()));
5303 }
5304
5305 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5306
5307 bpstat
5308 build_bpstat_chain (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5309 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5310 {
5311 struct breakpoint *b;
5312 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
5313
5314 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5315 {
5316 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
5317 continue;
5318
5319 for (bp_location *bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
5320 {
5321 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5322 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5323 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5324 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5325 checked all locations already. */
5326 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
5327 break;
5328
5329 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled)
5330 continue;
5331
5332 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
5333 continue;
5334
5335 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5336 matches. */
5337
5338 bpstat bs = new bpstats (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5339 explain stop. */
5340
5341 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5342 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5343 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5344 bs->stop = 1;
5345 bs->print = 1;
5346
5347 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5348 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5349 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5350 iteration. */
5351 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
5352 {
5353 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
5354
5355 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5356 }
5357 }
5358 }
5359
5360 /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
5361 if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()
5362 || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())
5363 {
5364 for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
5365 {
5366 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr)
5367 && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc))
5368 {
5369 bpstat bs = new bpstats (loc, &bs_link);
5370 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5371 bs->stop = 0;
5372 bs->print = 0;
5373 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5374 }
5375 }
5376 }
5377
5378 return bs_head;
5379 }
5380
5381 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5382
5383 bpstat
5384 bpstat_stop_status (const address_space *aspace,
5385 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, thread_info *thread,
5386 const struct target_waitstatus *ws,
5387 bpstat stop_chain)
5388 {
5389 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
5390 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5391 bpstat bs_head = stop_chain;
5392 bpstat bs;
5393 int need_remove_insert;
5394 int removed_any;
5395
5396 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5397 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5398 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5399 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5400 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5401 inferior function calls. */
5402 if (bs_head == NULL)
5403 bs_head = build_bpstat_chain (aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5404
5405 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5406 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5407 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5408 "catch unload". */
5409 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5410 {
5411 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
5412 {
5413 handle_solib_event ();
5414 break;
5415 }
5416 }
5417
5418 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5419 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5420 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5421
5422 removed_any = 0;
5423
5424 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5425 {
5426 if (!bs->stop)
5427 continue;
5428
5429 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5430 b->ops->check_status (bs);
5431 if (bs->stop)
5432 {
5433 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, thread);
5434
5435 if (bs->stop)
5436 {
5437 ++(b->hit_count);
5438 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5439
5440 /* We will stop here. */
5441 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5442 {
5443 --(b->enable_count);
5444 if (b->enable_count <= 0)
5445 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5446 removed_any = 1;
5447 }
5448 if (b->silent)
5449 bs->print = 0;
5450 bs->commands = b->commands;
5451 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5452 ? bs->commands.get () : NULL))
5453 bs->print = 0;
5454
5455 b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
5456 }
5457
5458 }
5459
5460 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5461 print. */
5462 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5463 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5464 }
5465
5466 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5467 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5468 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5469 done later. */
5470 need_remove_insert = 0;
5471 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5472 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5473 if (!bs->stop
5474 && bs->breakpoint_at
5475 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5476 {
5477 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5478
5479 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5480 need_remove_insert = 1;
5481 }
5482
5483 if (need_remove_insert)
5484 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
5485 else if (removed_any)
5486 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
5487
5488 return bs_head;
5489 }
5490
5491 static void
5492 handle_jit_event (void)
5493 {
5494 struct frame_info *frame;
5495 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5496
5497 if (debug_infrun)
5498 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "handling bp_jit_event\n");
5499
5500 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5501 breakpoint_re_set. */
5502 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
5503
5504 frame = get_current_frame ();
5505 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5506
5507 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
5508
5509 target_terminal::inferior ();
5510 }
5511
5512 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5513
5514 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5515
5516 struct bpstat_what
5517 bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
5518 {
5519 struct bpstat_what retval;
5520 bpstat bs;
5521
5522 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5523 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5524 retval.is_longjmp = 0;
5525
5526 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5527 {
5528 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5529 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5530 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5531 enum bptype bptype;
5532
5533 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5534 {
5535 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5536 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5537 bptype = bp_none;
5538 }
5539 else
5540 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5541
5542 switch (bptype)
5543 {
5544 case bp_none:
5545 break;
5546 case bp_breakpoint:
5547 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5548 case bp_single_step:
5549 case bp_until:
5550 case bp_finish:
5551 case bp_shlib_event:
5552 if (bs->stop)
5553 {
5554 if (bs->print)
5555 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5556 else
5557 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5558 }
5559 else
5560 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5561 break;
5562 case bp_watchpoint:
5563 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5564 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5565 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5566 if (bs->stop)
5567 {
5568 if (bs->print)
5569 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5570 else
5571 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5572 }
5573 else
5574 {
5575 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5576 This requires no further action. */
5577 }
5578 break;
5579 case bp_longjmp:
5580 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5581 case bp_exception:
5582 if (bs->stop)
5583 {
5584 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5585 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5586 }
5587 else
5588 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5589 break;
5590 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5591 case bp_exception_resume:
5592 if (bs->stop)
5593 {
5594 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5595 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5596 }
5597 else
5598 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5599 break;
5600 case bp_step_resume:
5601 if (bs->stop)
5602 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5603 else
5604 {
5605 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5606 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5607 }
5608 break;
5609 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5610 if (bs->stop)
5611 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5612 else
5613 {
5614 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5615 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5616 }
5617 break;
5618 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5619 case bp_thread_event:
5620 case bp_overlay_event:
5621 case bp_longjmp_master:
5622 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5623 case bp_exception_master:
5624 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5625 break;
5626 case bp_catchpoint:
5627 if (bs->stop)
5628 {
5629 if (bs->print)
5630 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5631 else
5632 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5633 }
5634 else
5635 {
5636 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5637 This requires no further action. */
5638 }
5639 break;
5640 case bp_jit_event:
5641 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5642 break;
5643 case bp_call_dummy:
5644 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5645 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5646 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5647 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5648 break;
5649 case bp_std_terminate:
5650 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5651 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5652 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5653 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5654 break;
5655 case bp_tracepoint:
5656 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5657 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5658 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5659 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5660 out already. */
5661 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5662 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5663 break;
5664 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5665 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5666 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5667 break;
5668 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5669 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5670 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5671 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5672 break;
5673
5674 case bp_dprintf:
5675 if (bs->stop)
5676 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5677 else
5678 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5679 break;
5680
5681 default:
5682 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5683 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5684 }
5685
5686 retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action);
5687 }
5688
5689 return retval;
5690 }
5691
5692 void
5693 bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat bs_head)
5694 {
5695 bpstat bs;
5696
5697 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5698 {
5699 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5700
5701 if (b == NULL)
5702 continue;
5703 switch (b->type)
5704 {
5705 case bp_jit_event:
5706 handle_jit_event ();
5707 break;
5708 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5709 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
5710 break;
5711 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5712 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
5713 break;
5714 }
5715 }
5716 }
5717
5718 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
5719 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
5720 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
5721
5722 int
5723 bpstat_should_step (void)
5724 {
5725 struct breakpoint *b;
5726
5727 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5728 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
5729 return 1;
5730 return 0;
5731 }
5732
5733 int
5734 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
5735 {
5736 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5737 if (bs->stop)
5738 return 1;
5739
5740 return 0;
5741 }
5742
5743 \f
5744
5745 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
5746 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
5747 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
5748
5749 static char *
5750 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
5751 {
5752 static char wrap_indent[80];
5753 int i, total_width, width, align;
5754 const char *text;
5755
5756 total_width = 0;
5757 for (i = 1; uiout->query_table_field (i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
5758 {
5759 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
5760 {
5761 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
5762 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
5763 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
5764
5765 return wrap_indent;
5766 }
5767
5768 total_width += width + 1;
5769 }
5770
5771 return NULL;
5772 }
5773
5774 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
5775 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
5776
5777 "host": Host evals condition.
5778 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
5779 "target": Target evals condition.
5780 */
5781
5782 static const char *
5783 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
5784 {
5785 struct bp_location *bl;
5786 char host_evals = 0;
5787 char target_evals = 0;
5788
5789 if (!b)
5790 return NULL;
5791
5792 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
5793 return NULL;
5794
5795 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5796 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5797 return condition_evaluation_host;
5798
5799 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5800 {
5801 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
5802 target_evals++;
5803 else
5804 host_evals++;
5805 }
5806
5807 if (host_evals && target_evals)
5808 return condition_evaluation_both;
5809 else if (target_evals)
5810 return condition_evaluation_target;
5811 else
5812 return condition_evaluation_host;
5813 }
5814
5815 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
5816 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
5817
5818 static const char *
5819 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
5820 {
5821 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
5822 return NULL;
5823
5824 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5825 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5826 return condition_evaluation_host;
5827
5828 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
5829 return condition_evaluation_target;
5830 else
5831 return condition_evaluation_host;
5832 }
5833
5834 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
5835
5836 static void
5837 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
5838 struct bp_location *loc)
5839 {
5840 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5841
5842 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
5843
5844 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
5845 loc = NULL;
5846
5847 if (loc != NULL)
5848 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
5849
5850 if (b->display_canonical)
5851 uiout->field_string ("what", event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5852 else if (loc && loc->symtab)
5853 {
5854 const struct symbol *sym = loc->symbol;
5855
5856 if (sym)
5857 {
5858 uiout->text ("in ");
5859 uiout->field_string ("func", SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym),
5860 ui_out_style_kind::FUNCTION);
5861 uiout->text (" ");
5862 uiout->wrap_hint (wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
5863 uiout->text ("at ");
5864 }
5865 uiout->field_string ("file",
5866 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab),
5867 ui_out_style_kind::FILE);
5868 uiout->text (":");
5869
5870 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
5871 uiout->field_string ("fullname", symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
5872
5873 uiout->field_int ("line", loc->line_number);
5874 }
5875 else if (loc)
5876 {
5877 string_file stb;
5878
5879 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, &stb,
5880 demangle, "");
5881 uiout->field_stream ("at", stb);
5882 }
5883 else
5884 {
5885 uiout->field_string ("pending",
5886 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5887 /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition
5888 or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed,
5889 too, but only for non-MI streams. */
5890 if (!uiout->is_mi_like_p () && b->extra_string != NULL)
5891 {
5892 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
5893 uiout->text (",");
5894 else
5895 uiout->text (" ");
5896 uiout->text (b->extra_string);
5897 }
5898 }
5899
5900 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
5901 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
5902 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
5903 {
5904 uiout->text (" (");
5905 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
5906 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
5907 uiout->text (")");
5908 }
5909 }
5910
5911 static const char *
5912 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
5913 {
5914 struct ep_type_description
5915 {
5916 enum bptype type;
5917 const char *description;
5918 };
5919 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
5920 {
5921 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
5922 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
5923 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
5924 {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"},
5925 {bp_until, "until"},
5926 {bp_finish, "finish"},
5927 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
5928 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
5929 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
5930 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
5931 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
5932 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
5933 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
5934 {bp_exception, "exception"},
5935 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
5936 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
5937 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
5938 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
5939 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
5940 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
5941 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
5942 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
5943 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
5944 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
5945 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
5946 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
5947 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
5948 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
5949 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
5950 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
5951 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
5952 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
5953 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
5954 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
5955 };
5956
5957 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
5958 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
5959 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5960 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
5961 (int) type);
5962
5963 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
5964 }
5965
5966 /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
5967 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
5968
5969 static void
5970 output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
5971 const char *field_name,
5972 const std::vector<int> &inf_nums,
5973 int mi_only)
5974 {
5975 int is_mi = uiout->is_mi_like_p ();
5976
5977 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
5978 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
5979 if (!is_mi && mi_only)
5980 return;
5981
5982 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (uiout, field_name);
5983
5984 for (size_t i = 0; i < inf_nums.size (); i++)
5985 {
5986 if (is_mi)
5987 {
5988 char mi_group[10];
5989
5990 xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf_nums[i]);
5991 uiout->field_string (NULL, mi_group);
5992 }
5993 else
5994 {
5995 if (i == 0)
5996 uiout->text (" inf ");
5997 else
5998 uiout->text (", ");
5999
6000 uiout->text (plongest (inf_nums[i]));
6001 }
6002 }
6003 }
6004
6005 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
6006
6007 static void
6008 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6009 struct bp_location *loc,
6010 int loc_number,
6011 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6012 int allflag)
6013 {
6014 struct command_line *l;
6015 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
6016
6017 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6018 int header_of_multiple = 0;
6019 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
6020 struct value_print_options opts;
6021
6022 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6023
6024 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
6025 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
6026 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
6027 if (loc == NULL
6028 && (b->loc != NULL
6029 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
6030 header_of_multiple = 1;
6031 if (loc == NULL)
6032 loc = b->loc;
6033
6034 annotate_record ();
6035
6036 /* 1 */
6037 annotate_field (0);
6038 if (part_of_multiple)
6039 uiout->field_fmt ("number", "%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
6040 else
6041 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
6042
6043 /* 2 */
6044 annotate_field (1);
6045 if (part_of_multiple)
6046 uiout->field_skip ("type");
6047 else
6048 uiout->field_string ("type", bptype_string (b->type));
6049
6050 /* 3 */
6051 annotate_field (2);
6052 if (part_of_multiple)
6053 uiout->field_skip ("disp");
6054 else
6055 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
6056
6057 /* 4 */
6058 annotate_field (3);
6059 if (part_of_multiple)
6060 uiout->field_string ("enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
6061 else
6062 uiout->field_fmt ("enabled", "%c", bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
6063
6064 /* 5 and 6 */
6065 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
6066 {
6067 /* Although the print_one can possibly print all locations,
6068 calling it here is not likely to get any nice result. So,
6069 make sure there's just one location. */
6070 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
6071 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
6072 }
6073 else
6074 switch (b->type)
6075 {
6076 case bp_none:
6077 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6078 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
6079 break;
6080
6081 case bp_watchpoint:
6082 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6083 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6084 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6085 {
6086 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6087
6088 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6089 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6090 is relatively readable). */
6091 if (opts.addressprint)
6092 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
6093 annotate_field (5);
6094 uiout->field_string ("what", w->exp_string);
6095 }
6096 break;
6097
6098 case bp_breakpoint:
6099 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6100 case bp_single_step:
6101 case bp_until:
6102 case bp_finish:
6103 case bp_longjmp:
6104 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6105 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6106 case bp_exception:
6107 case bp_exception_resume:
6108 case bp_step_resume:
6109 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6110 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6111 case bp_call_dummy:
6112 case bp_std_terminate:
6113 case bp_shlib_event:
6114 case bp_thread_event:
6115 case bp_overlay_event:
6116 case bp_longjmp_master:
6117 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6118 case bp_exception_master:
6119 case bp_tracepoint:
6120 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6121 case bp_static_tracepoint:
6122 case bp_dprintf:
6123 case bp_jit_event:
6124 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6125 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6126 if (opts.addressprint)
6127 {
6128 annotate_field (4);
6129 if (header_of_multiple)
6130 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
6131 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
6132 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<PENDING>");
6133 else
6134 uiout->field_core_addr ("addr",
6135 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
6136 }
6137 annotate_field (5);
6138 if (!header_of_multiple)
6139 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
6140 if (b->loc)
6141 *last_loc = b->loc;
6142 break;
6143 }
6144
6145
6146 if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
6147 {
6148 std::vector<int> inf_nums;
6149 int mi_only = 1;
6150
6151 for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ())
6152 {
6153 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
6154 inf_nums.push_back (inf->num);
6155 }
6156
6157 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6158 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6159 if (allflag
6160 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6161 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
6162 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6163 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6164 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6165 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
6166 mi_only = 0;
6167 output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_nums, mi_only);
6168 }
6169
6170 if (!part_of_multiple)
6171 {
6172 if (b->thread != -1)
6173 {
6174 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6175 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6176 uiout->text (" thread ");
6177 uiout->field_int ("thread", b->thread);
6178 }
6179 else if (b->task != 0)
6180 {
6181 uiout->text (" task ");
6182 uiout->field_int ("task", b->task);
6183 }
6184 }
6185
6186 uiout->text ("\n");
6187
6188 if (!part_of_multiple)
6189 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
6190
6191 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
6192 {
6193 annotate_field (6);
6194 uiout->text ("\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6195 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6196 the frame ID. */
6197 uiout->field_core_addr ("frame",
6198 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
6199 uiout->text ("\n");
6200 }
6201
6202 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
6203 {
6204 annotate_field (7);
6205 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6206 uiout->text ("\ttrace only if ");
6207 else
6208 uiout->text ("\tstop only if ");
6209 uiout->field_string ("cond", b->cond_string);
6210
6211 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6212 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6213 if (is_breakpoint (b)
6214 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6215 == condition_evaluation_target)
6216 {
6217 uiout->text (" (");
6218 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
6219 bp_condition_evaluator (b));
6220 uiout->text (" evals)");
6221 }
6222 uiout->text ("\n");
6223 }
6224
6225 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
6226 {
6227 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6228 uiout->text ("\tstop only in thread ");
6229 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6230 uiout->field_int ("thread", b->thread);
6231 else
6232 {
6233 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread);
6234
6235 uiout->field_string ("thread", print_thread_id (thr));
6236 }
6237 uiout->text ("\n");
6238 }
6239
6240 if (!part_of_multiple)
6241 {
6242 if (b->hit_count)
6243 {
6244 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6245 if (is_catchpoint (b))
6246 uiout->text ("\tcatchpoint");
6247 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
6248 uiout->text ("\ttracepoint");
6249 else
6250 uiout->text ("\tbreakpoint");
6251 uiout->text (" already hit ");
6252 uiout->field_int ("times", b->hit_count);
6253 if (b->hit_count == 1)
6254 uiout->text (" time\n");
6255 else
6256 uiout->text (" times\n");
6257 }
6258 else
6259 {
6260 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6261 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6262 uiout->field_int ("times", b->hit_count);
6263 }
6264 }
6265
6266 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
6267 {
6268 annotate_field (8);
6269 uiout->text ("\tignore next ");
6270 uiout->field_int ("ignore", b->ignore_count);
6271 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6272 }
6273
6274 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6275 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6276 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6277 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
6278 {
6279 annotate_field (8);
6280 uiout->text ("\tdisable after ");
6281 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6282 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6283 if (b->ignore_count)
6284 uiout->text ("additional ");
6285 else
6286 uiout->text ("next ");
6287 uiout->field_int ("enable", b->enable_count);
6288 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6289 }
6290
6291 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
6292 {
6293 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6294
6295 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
6296 {
6297 uiout->text ("\ttrace buffer usage ");
6298 uiout->field_int ("traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
6299 uiout->text (" bytes\n");
6300 }
6301 }
6302
6303 l = b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
6304 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
6305 {
6306 annotate_field (9);
6307 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "script");
6308 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
6309 }
6310
6311 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6312 {
6313 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6314
6315 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
6316 {
6317 annotate_field (10);
6318 uiout->text ("\tpass count ");
6319 uiout->field_int ("pass", t->pass_count);
6320 uiout->text (" \n");
6321 }
6322
6323 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6324 pending. */
6325 if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
6326 {
6327 annotate_field (11);
6328
6329 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6330 uiout->field_string ("installed",
6331 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
6332 else
6333 {
6334 if (loc->inserted)
6335 uiout->text ("\t");
6336 else
6337 uiout->text ("\tnot ");
6338 uiout->text ("installed on target\n");
6339 }
6340 }
6341 }
6342
6343 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && !part_of_multiple)
6344 {
6345 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6346 {
6347 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6348
6349 uiout->field_string ("original-location", w->exp_string);
6350 }
6351 else if (b->location != NULL
6352 && event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()) != NULL)
6353 uiout->field_string ("original-location",
6354 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
6355 }
6356 }
6357
6358 static void
6359 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6360 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6361 int allflag)
6362 {
6363 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6364
6365 {
6366 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "bkpt");
6367
6368 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag);
6369 }
6370
6371 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6372 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6373 locations, if any. */
6374 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
6375 {
6376 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6377 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6378 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6379 situation.
6380
6381 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6382 internally, that's not a property exposed to user. */
6383 if (b->loc
6384 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
6385 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled))
6386 {
6387 struct bp_location *loc;
6388 int n = 1;
6389
6390 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
6391 {
6392 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, NULL);
6393 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc, allflag);
6394 }
6395 }
6396 }
6397 }
6398
6399 static int
6400 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
6401 {
6402 int print_address_bits = 0;
6403 struct bp_location *loc;
6404
6405 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have an
6406 address to print. */
6407 if (is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (b))
6408 return 0;
6409
6410 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
6411 {
6412 int addr_bit;
6413
6414 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
6415 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6416 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6417 }
6418
6419 return print_address_bits;
6420 }
6421
6422 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6423
6424 void
6425 print_breakpoint (breakpoint *b)
6426 {
6427 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
6428 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
6429 }
6430
6431 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6432 internal or momentary. */
6433
6434 int
6435 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6436 {
6437 return b->number > 0;
6438 }
6439
6440 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6441
6442 int
6443 pending_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6444 {
6445 return b->loc == NULL;
6446 }
6447
6448 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
6449 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints.
6450 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints. If
6451 FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6452 ones for which it returns non-zero. Return the total number of
6453 breakpoints listed. */
6454
6455 static int
6456 breakpoint_1 (const char *args, int allflag,
6457 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
6458 {
6459 struct breakpoint *b;
6460 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6461 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6462 struct value_print_options opts;
6463 int print_address_bits = 0;
6464 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6465 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6466
6467 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6468
6469 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6470 required for address fields. */
6471 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6472 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6473 {
6474 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6475 if (filter && !filter (b))
6476 continue;
6477
6478 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6479 accept. Skip the others. */
6480 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6481 {
6482 if (allflag && parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6483 continue;
6484 if (!allflag && !number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6485 continue;
6486 }
6487
6488 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6489 {
6490 int addr_bit, type_len;
6491
6492 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6493 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6494 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6495
6496 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6497 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6498 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6499
6500 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6501 }
6502 }
6503
6504 {
6505 ui_out_emit_table table_emitter (uiout,
6506 opts.addressprint ? 6 : 5,
6507 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6508 "BreakpointTable");
6509
6510 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6511 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6512 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6513 annotate_field (0);
6514 uiout->table_header (7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6515 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6516 annotate_field (1);
6517 uiout->table_header (print_type_col_width, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6518 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6519 annotate_field (2);
6520 uiout->table_header (4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6521 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6522 annotate_field (3);
6523 uiout->table_header (3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6524 if (opts.addressprint)
6525 {
6526 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6527 annotate_field (4);
6528 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6529 uiout->table_header (10, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6530 else
6531 uiout->table_header (18, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6532 }
6533 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6534 annotate_field (5);
6535 uiout->table_header (40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6536 uiout->table_body ();
6537 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6538 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6539
6540 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6541 {
6542 QUIT;
6543 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6544 if (filter && !filter (b))
6545 continue;
6546
6547 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6548 accept. Skip the others. */
6549
6550 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6551 {
6552 if (allflag) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6553 {
6554 if (parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6555 continue;
6556 }
6557 else /* all others */
6558 {
6559 if (!number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6560 continue;
6561 }
6562 }
6563 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6564 allflag is set. */
6565 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6566 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, allflag);
6567 }
6568 }
6569
6570 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6571 {
6572 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6573 empty list. */
6574 if (!filter)
6575 {
6576 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6577 uiout->message ("No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6578 else
6579 uiout->message ("No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6580 args);
6581 }
6582 }
6583 else
6584 {
6585 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6586 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6587 }
6588
6589 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6590 there have been breakpoints? */
6591 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6592
6593 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6594 }
6595
6596 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6597 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6598
6599 static void
6600 default_collect_info (void)
6601 {
6602 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6603
6604 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6605 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6606 not wanted. */
6607 if (!*default_collect)
6608 return;
6609
6610 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6611 actions. */
6612 uiout->text ("default collect ");
6613 uiout->field_string ("default-collect", default_collect);
6614 uiout->text (" \n");
6615 }
6616
6617 static void
6618 info_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6619 {
6620 breakpoint_1 (args, 0, NULL);
6621
6622 default_collect_info ();
6623 }
6624
6625 static void
6626 info_watchpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6627 {
6628 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_watchpoint);
6629 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6630
6631 if (num_printed == 0)
6632 {
6633 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6634 uiout->message ("No watchpoints.\n");
6635 else
6636 uiout->message ("No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
6637 }
6638 }
6639
6640 static void
6641 maintenance_info_breakpoints (const char *args, int from_tty)
6642 {
6643 breakpoint_1 (args, 1, NULL);
6644
6645 default_collect_info ();
6646 }
6647
6648 static int
6649 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
6650 struct program_space *pspace,
6651 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
6652 {
6653 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
6654
6655 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
6656 {
6657 if (bl->pspace == pspace
6658 && bl->address == pc
6659 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
6660 return 1;
6661 }
6662 return 0;
6663 }
6664
6665 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
6666 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
6667 address spaces. */
6668
6669 static void
6670 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6671 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
6672 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
6673 {
6674 int others = 0;
6675 struct breakpoint *b;
6676
6677 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6678 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
6679 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
6680 if (others > 0)
6681 {
6682 if (others == 1)
6683 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
6684 else /* if (others == ???) */
6685 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
6686 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6687 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
6688 {
6689 others--;
6690 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
6691 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
6692 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
6693 else if (b->thread != -1)
6694 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
6695 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
6696 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
6697 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6698 ? " (disabled)"
6699 : ""),
6700 (others > 1) ? ","
6701 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
6702 }
6703 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
6704 fputs_styled (paddress (gdbarch, pc), address_style.style (), gdb_stdout);
6705 printf_filtered (".\n");
6706 }
6707 }
6708 \f
6709
6710 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
6711 BPT locations. For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members
6712 are irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to other
6713 addresses (or use them for any other purpose either).
6714
6715 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will
6716 always have a zero valued location address and we don't want to mark
6717 breakpoints of any of these types to be a duplicate of an actual
6718 breakpoint location at address zero:
6719
6720 bp_watchpoint
6721 bp_catchpoint
6722
6723 */
6724
6725 static int
6726 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
6727 {
6728 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
6729
6730 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
6731 }
6732
6733 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
6734 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
6735
6736 static int
6737 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6738 struct bp_location *loc2)
6739 {
6740 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
6741 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
6742
6743 /* Both of them must exist. */
6744 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
6745 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
6746
6747 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
6748 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
6749 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
6750 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
6751 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
6752 other watchpoint. */
6753 if ((w1->cond_exp
6754 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
6755 loc1->length,
6756 loc1->watchpoint_type,
6757 w1->cond_exp.get ()))
6758 || (w2->cond_exp
6759 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
6760 loc2->length,
6761 loc2->watchpoint_type,
6762 w2->cond_exp.get ())))
6763 return 0;
6764
6765 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
6766 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
6767 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
6768 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
6769 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
6770 become hw_access locations later. */
6771 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
6772 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
6773 && loc1->address == loc2->address
6774 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6775 }
6776
6777 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6778
6779 int
6780 breakpoint_address_match (const address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
6781 const address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
6782 {
6783 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6784 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6785 && addr1 == addr2);
6786 }
6787
6788 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
6789 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
6790 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
6791 space doesn't really matter. */
6792
6793 static int
6794 breakpoint_address_match_range (const address_space *aspace1,
6795 CORE_ADDR addr1,
6796 int len1, const address_space *aspace2,
6797 CORE_ADDR addr2)
6798 {
6799 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6800 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6801 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
6802 }
6803
6804 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
6805 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
6806 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
6807 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
6808
6809 static int
6810 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
6811 const address_space *aspace,
6812 CORE_ADDR addr)
6813 {
6814 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
6815 aspace, addr)
6816 || (bl->length
6817 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
6818 bl->address, bl->length,
6819 aspace, addr)));
6820 }
6821
6822 /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps
6823 breakpoint BL. BL may be a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a
6824 match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address
6825 space. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space
6826 doesn't really matter. */
6827
6828 static int
6829 breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl,
6830 const address_space *aspace,
6831 CORE_ADDR addr, int len)
6832 {
6833 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6834 || bl->pspace->aspace == aspace)
6835 {
6836 int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1;
6837
6838 if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len))
6839 return 1;
6840 }
6841 return 0;
6842 }
6843
6844 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
6845 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
6846 true, otherwise returns false. */
6847
6848 static int
6849 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6850 struct bp_location *loc2)
6851 {
6852 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6853 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
6854 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
6855 different locations. */
6856 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
6857 else
6858 return 0;
6859 }
6860
6861 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
6862 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
6863 represent the same location. */
6864
6865 static int
6866 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6867 struct bp_location *loc2)
6868 {
6869 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
6870
6871 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
6872 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
6873 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
6874
6875 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
6876 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
6877
6878 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
6879 return 0;
6880 else if (hw_point1)
6881 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6882 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6883 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6884 else
6885 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged breakpoints. */
6886 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
6887 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
6888 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6889 }
6890
6891 static void
6892 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
6893 int bnum, int have_bnum)
6894 {
6895 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
6896 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
6897 char astr1[64];
6898 char astr2[64];
6899
6900 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
6901 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
6902 if (have_bnum)
6903 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
6904 bnum, astr1, astr2);
6905 else
6906 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
6907 }
6908
6909 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
6910 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
6911 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
6912 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
6913
6914 static CORE_ADDR
6915 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6916 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
6917 {
6918 if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
6919 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
6920 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
6921 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
6922 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
6923 {
6924 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
6925 have their addresses modified. */
6926 return bpaddr;
6927 }
6928 else if (bptype == bp_single_step)
6929 {
6930 /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
6931 modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
6932 applies to this address, then it should have already been
6933 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
6934 first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
6935 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
6936 return bpaddr;
6937 }
6938 else
6939 {
6940 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr = bpaddr;
6941
6942 if (gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
6943 {
6944 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
6945 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
6946 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
6947 }
6948
6949 adjusted_bpaddr = address_significant (gdbarch, adjusted_bpaddr);
6950
6951 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
6952 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
6953 is required. */
6954 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
6955 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
6956
6957 return adjusted_bpaddr;
6958 }
6959 }
6960
6961 bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner)
6962 {
6963 bp_location *loc = this;
6964
6965 loc->owner = owner;
6966 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
6967 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
6968 loc->enabled = 1;
6969
6970 switch (owner->type)
6971 {
6972 case bp_breakpoint:
6973 case bp_single_step:
6974 case bp_until:
6975 case bp_finish:
6976 case bp_longjmp:
6977 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6978 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6979 case bp_exception:
6980 case bp_exception_resume:
6981 case bp_step_resume:
6982 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6983 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6984 case bp_call_dummy:
6985 case bp_std_terminate:
6986 case bp_shlib_event:
6987 case bp_thread_event:
6988 case bp_overlay_event:
6989 case bp_jit_event:
6990 case bp_longjmp_master:
6991 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6992 case bp_exception_master:
6993 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6994 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6995 case bp_dprintf:
6996 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
6997 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
6998 break;
6999 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
7000 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
7001 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7002 break;
7003 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
7004 case bp_read_watchpoint:
7005 case bp_access_watchpoint:
7006 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
7007 break;
7008 case bp_watchpoint:
7009 case bp_catchpoint:
7010 case bp_tracepoint:
7011 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
7012 case bp_static_tracepoint:
7013 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
7014 break;
7015 default:
7016 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
7017 }
7018
7019 loc->refc = 1;
7020 }
7021
7022 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
7023
7024 static struct bp_location *
7025 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7026 {
7027 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
7028 }
7029
7030 static void
7031 free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
7032 {
7033 delete loc;
7034 }
7035
7036 /* Increment reference count. */
7037
7038 static void
7039 incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
7040 {
7041 ++bl->refc;
7042 }
7043
7044 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
7045 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
7046
7047 static void
7048 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
7049 {
7050 gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
7051
7052 if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
7053 free_bp_location (*blp);
7054 *blp = NULL;
7055 }
7056
7057 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7058
7059 static breakpoint *
7060 add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b)
7061 {
7062 struct breakpoint *b1;
7063 struct breakpoint *result = b.get ();
7064
7065 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7066 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7067
7068 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
7069 if (b1 == 0)
7070 breakpoint_chain = b.release ();
7071 else
7072 {
7073 while (b1->next)
7074 b1 = b1->next;
7075 b1->next = b.release ();
7076 }
7077
7078 return result;
7079 }
7080
7081 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7082
7083 static void
7084 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
7085 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7086 enum bptype bptype,
7087 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7088 {
7089 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7090
7091 b->ops = ops;
7092 b->type = bptype;
7093 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
7094 b->language = current_language->la_language;
7095 b->input_radix = input_radix;
7096 b->related_breakpoint = b;
7097 }
7098
7099 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7100 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7101
7102 static struct breakpoint *
7103 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7104 enum bptype bptype,
7105 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7106 {
7107 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7108
7109 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7110 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7111 }
7112
7113 /* Initialize loc->function_name. EXPLICIT_LOC says no indirect function
7114 resolutions should be made as the user specified the location explicitly
7115 enough. */
7116
7117 static void
7118 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc, int explicit_loc)
7119 {
7120 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
7121
7122 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
7123 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
7124 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
7125 {
7126 const char *function_name;
7127
7128 if (loc->msymbol != NULL
7129 && (MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_text_gnu_ifunc
7130 || MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_data_gnu_ifunc)
7131 && !explicit_loc)
7132 {
7133 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7134
7135 function_name = MSYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (loc->msymbol);
7136
7137 if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
7138 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
7139 {
7140 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7141 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7142 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
7143 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7144 breakpoint. */
7145 loc->related_address = loc->address;
7146 }
7147 }
7148 else
7149 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &function_name, NULL, NULL);
7150
7151 if (function_name)
7152 loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
7153 }
7154 }
7155
7156 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7157 struct gdbarch *
7158 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7159 {
7160 if (sal.section)
7161 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
7162 if (sal.symtab)
7163 return get_objfile_arch (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab));
7164
7165 return NULL;
7166 }
7167
7168 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7169 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7170 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7171
7172 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7173 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7174 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7175
7176 static void
7177 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7178 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7179 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7180 {
7181 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7182
7183 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7184
7185 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
7186 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
7187
7188 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7189 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7190 program space. */
7191 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7192 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
7193 }
7194
7195 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7196 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7197 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7198 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7199 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7200 is also returned as the value of this function.
7201
7202 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7203 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7204 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7205 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7206 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7207 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7208 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7209
7210 struct breakpoint *
7211 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7212 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7213 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7214 {
7215 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7216
7217 init_raw_breakpoint (b.get (), gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
7218 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7219 }
7220
7221 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7222 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7223 initiated the operation. */
7224
7225 void
7226 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
7227 {
7228 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7229 int thread = tp->global_num;
7230
7231 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7232 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7233 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7234 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7235 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7236 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7237 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
7238 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
7239 {
7240 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
7241 struct breakpoint *clone;
7242
7243 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7244 after their removal. */
7245 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
7246 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7247 clone->thread = thread;
7248 }
7249
7250 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
7251 }
7252
7253 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7254 void
7255 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
7256 {
7257 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7258
7259 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7260 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7261 {
7262 if (b->thread == thread)
7263 delete_breakpoint (b);
7264 }
7265 }
7266
7267 void
7268 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
7269 {
7270 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7271
7272 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7273 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7274 {
7275 if (b->thread == thread)
7276 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7277 }
7278 }
7279
7280 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7281 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7282 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7283 breakpoints. */
7284
7285 struct breakpoint *
7286 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7287 {
7288 struct breakpoint *b, *retval = NULL;
7289
7290 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7291 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
7292 {
7293 struct breakpoint *new_b;
7294
7295 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
7296 &momentary_breakpoint_ops,
7297 1);
7298 new_b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
7299
7300 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7301
7302 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
7303 if (retval == NULL)
7304 retval = new_b;
7305 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
7306 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
7307 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
7308 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
7309 }
7310
7311 return retval;
7312 }
7313
7314 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7315 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7316 stack.
7317
7318 You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently
7319 unwind the whole stack. Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy
7320 frames. */
7321
7322 void
7323 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
7324 {
7325 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7326
7327 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7328 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->global_num)
7329 {
7330 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
7331
7332 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
7333 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
7334 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
7335 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
7336 continue;
7337
7338 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp);
7339
7340 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
7341 {
7342 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
7343 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
7344 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
7345 }
7346 delete_breakpoint (b);
7347 }
7348 }
7349
7350 void
7351 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7352 {
7353 struct breakpoint *b;
7354
7355 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7356 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7357 {
7358 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7359 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7360 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
7361 }
7362 }
7363
7364 void
7365 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7366 {
7367 struct breakpoint *b;
7368
7369 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7370 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7371 {
7372 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
7373 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
7374 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
7375 }
7376 }
7377
7378 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7379 master breakpoint. */
7380 void
7381 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7382 {
7383 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7384
7385 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7386 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7387 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
7388 {
7389 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
7390 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7391 }
7392 }
7393
7394 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7395 void
7396 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7397 {
7398 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7399
7400 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7401 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
7402 delete_breakpoint (b);
7403 }
7404
7405 struct breakpoint *
7406 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7407 {
7408 struct breakpoint *b;
7409
7410 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
7411 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7412
7413 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7414 /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7415 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
7416
7417 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7418
7419 return b;
7420 }
7421
7422 struct lang_and_radix
7423 {
7424 enum language lang;
7425 int radix;
7426 };
7427
7428 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7429
7430 struct breakpoint *
7431 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7432 {
7433 return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7434 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7435 }
7436
7437 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7438
7439 void
7440 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7441 {
7442 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7443
7444 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7445 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7446 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7447 delete_breakpoint (b);
7448 }
7449
7450 void
7451 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7452 {
7453 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7454
7455 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7456 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7457 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7458 delete_breakpoint (b);
7459 }
7460
7461 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7462
7463 void
7464 remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
7465 {
7466 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7467
7468 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7469 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7470 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7471 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7472 }
7473
7474 /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
7475 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
7476 INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
7477
7478 static struct breakpoint *
7479 create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address,
7480 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
7481 {
7482 struct breakpoint *b;
7483
7484 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7485 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7486 update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode);
7487 return b;
7488 }
7489
7490 struct breakpoint *
7491 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7492 {
7493 return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7494 }
7495
7496 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7497
7498 struct breakpoint *
7499 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7500 {
7501 struct breakpoint *b;
7502
7503 /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
7504 locations. */
7505 b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT);
7506 if (!b->loc->inserted)
7507 {
7508 delete_breakpoint (b);
7509 return NULL;
7510 }
7511 return b;
7512 }
7513
7514 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7515 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7516
7517 void
7518 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7519 {
7520 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7521
7522 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7523 {
7524 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7525 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7526
7527 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7528 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7529 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7530 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7531 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7532 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7533 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7534 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7535 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7536 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7537 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7538 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7539 )
7540 {
7541 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7542 }
7543 }
7544 }
7545
7546 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7547 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7548 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7549
7550 static void
7551 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7552 {
7553 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7554 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7555
7556 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7557 {
7558 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7559 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7560
7561 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7562 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7563 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7564 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7565 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7566 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7567 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7568 || is_tracepoint (b))
7569 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7570 {
7571 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7572 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7573 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7574 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7575 loc->inserted = 0;
7576
7577 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7578 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7579
7580 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7581 {
7582 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
7583 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7584 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7585 solib->so_name);
7586 }
7587 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
7588 }
7589 }
7590 }
7591
7592 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
7593 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7594 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7595
7596 static void
7597 disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
7598 {
7599 struct breakpoint *b;
7600
7601 if (objfile == NULL)
7602 return;
7603
7604 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
7605 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
7606 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
7607 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
7608 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
7609 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
7610 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
7611 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
7612 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
7613 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
7614 main objfile). */
7615 if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
7616 || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
7617 return;
7618
7619 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7620 {
7621 struct bp_location *loc;
7622 int bp_modified = 0;
7623
7624 if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
7625 continue;
7626
7627 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
7628 {
7629 CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
7630
7631 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7632 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7633 continue;
7634
7635 if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
7636 continue;
7637
7638 if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
7639 continue;
7640
7641 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7642 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7643 continue;
7644
7645 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
7646 {
7647 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7648 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
7649 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
7650 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
7651 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
7652 unmapped. */
7653
7654 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7655
7656 bp_modified = 1;
7657 }
7658 }
7659
7660 if (bp_modified)
7661 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7662 }
7663 }
7664
7665 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
7666
7667 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
7668 catchpoint. A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points
7669 to CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7670
7671 struct fork_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7672 {
7673 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
7674 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
7675 catchpoint has triggered. */
7676 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
7677 };
7678
7679 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7680 catchpoints. */
7681
7682 static int
7683 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7684 {
7685 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7686 }
7687
7688 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7689 catchpoints. */
7690
7691 static int
7692 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7693 {
7694 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7695 }
7696
7697 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7698 catchpoints. */
7699
7700 static int
7701 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7702 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7703 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7704 {
7705 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7706
7707 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
7708 return 0;
7709
7710 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7711 return 1;
7712 }
7713
7714 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7715 catchpoints. */
7716
7717 static enum print_stop_action
7718 print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
7719 {
7720 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7721 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7722 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7723
7724 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7725 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7726 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7727 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7728 else
7729 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7730 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7731 {
7732 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
7733 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7734 }
7735 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
7736 uiout->text (" (forked process ");
7737 uiout->field_int ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7738 uiout->text ("), ");
7739 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7740 }
7741
7742 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7743 catchpoints. */
7744
7745 static void
7746 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7747 {
7748 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7749 struct value_print_options opts;
7750 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7751
7752 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7753
7754 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7755 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7756 readable). */
7757 if (opts.addressprint)
7758 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7759 annotate_field (5);
7760 uiout->text ("fork");
7761 if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
7762 {
7763 uiout->text (", process ");
7764 uiout->field_int ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7765 uiout->spaces (1);
7766 }
7767
7768 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7769 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "fork");
7770 }
7771
7772 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7773 catchpoints. */
7774
7775 static void
7776 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
7777 {
7778 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
7779 }
7780
7781 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7782 catchpoints. */
7783
7784 static void
7785 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7786 {
7787 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
7788 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7789 }
7790
7791 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
7792
7793 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
7794
7795 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7796 catchpoints. */
7797
7798 static int
7799 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
7800 {
7801 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7802 }
7803
7804 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7805 catchpoints. */
7806
7807 static int
7808 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7809 {
7810 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7811 }
7812
7813 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7814 catchpoints. */
7815
7816 static int
7817 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7818 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7819 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7820 {
7821 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7822
7823 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
7824 return 0;
7825
7826 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7827 return 1;
7828 }
7829
7830 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7831 catchpoints. */
7832
7833 static enum print_stop_action
7834 print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
7835 {
7836 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7837 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7838 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7839
7840 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7841 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7842 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7843 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7844 else
7845 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7846 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7847 {
7848 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
7849 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7850 }
7851 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
7852 uiout->text (" (vforked process ");
7853 uiout->field_int ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7854 uiout->text ("), ");
7855 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7856 }
7857
7858 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7859 catchpoints. */
7860
7861 static void
7862 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7863 {
7864 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7865 struct value_print_options opts;
7866 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7867
7868 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7869 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7870 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7871 readable). */
7872 if (opts.addressprint)
7873 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7874 annotate_field (5);
7875 uiout->text ("vfork");
7876 if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
7877 {
7878 uiout->text (", process ");
7879 uiout->field_int ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7880 uiout->spaces (1);
7881 }
7882
7883 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7884 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "vfork");
7885 }
7886
7887 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7888 catchpoints. */
7889
7890 static void
7891 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
7892 {
7893 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
7894 }
7895
7896 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7897 catchpoints. */
7898
7899 static void
7900 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7901 {
7902 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
7903 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7904 }
7905
7906 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
7907
7908 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
7909
7910 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
7911 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7912 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7913
7914 struct solib_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7915 {
7916 ~solib_catchpoint () override;
7917
7918 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
7919 unsigned char is_load;
7920
7921 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
7922 REGEX is non-NULL. */
7923 char *regex;
7924 std::unique_ptr<compiled_regex> compiled;
7925 };
7926
7927 solib_catchpoint::~solib_catchpoint ()
7928 {
7929 xfree (this->regex);
7930 }
7931
7932 static int
7933 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
7934 {
7935 return 0;
7936 }
7937
7938 static int
7939 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7940 {
7941 return 0;
7942 }
7943
7944 static int
7945 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
7946 const address_space *aspace,
7947 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7948 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7949 {
7950 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7951 struct breakpoint *other;
7952
7953 if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
7954 return 1;
7955
7956 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other)
7957 {
7958 struct bp_location *other_bl;
7959
7960 if (other == bl->owner)
7961 continue;
7962
7963 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
7964 continue;
7965
7966 if (self->pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->pspace)
7967 continue;
7968
7969 for (other_bl = other->loc; other_bl != NULL; other_bl = other_bl->next)
7970 {
7971 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
7972 return 1;
7973 }
7974 }
7975
7976 return 0;
7977 }
7978
7979 static void
7980 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
7981 {
7982 struct solib_catchpoint *self
7983 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7984
7985 if (self->is_load)
7986 {
7987 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
7988 {
7989 if (!self->regex
7990 || self->compiled->exec (iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
7991 return;
7992 }
7993 }
7994 else
7995 {
7996 for (const std::string &iter : current_program_space->deleted_solibs)
7997 {
7998 if (!self->regex
7999 || self->compiled->exec (iter.c_str (), 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8000 return;
8001 }
8002 }
8003
8004 bs->stop = 0;
8005 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
8006 }
8007
8008 static enum print_stop_action
8009 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
8010 {
8011 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8012 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8013
8014 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8015 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8016 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8017 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8018 else
8019 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8020 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
8021 uiout->text ("\n");
8022 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8023 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8024 print_solib_event (1);
8025 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8026 }
8027
8028 static void
8029 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
8030 {
8031 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8032 struct value_print_options opts;
8033 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8034
8035 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8036 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8037 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8038 readable). */
8039 if (opts.addressprint)
8040 {
8041 annotate_field (4);
8042 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8043 }
8044
8045 std::string msg;
8046 annotate_field (5);
8047 if (self->is_load)
8048 {
8049 if (self->regex)
8050 msg = string_printf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8051 else
8052 msg = _("load of library");
8053 }
8054 else
8055 {
8056 if (self->regex)
8057 msg = string_printf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8058 else
8059 msg = _("unload of library");
8060 }
8061 uiout->field_string ("what", msg);
8062
8063 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8064 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8065 }
8066
8067 static void
8068 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8069 {
8070 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8071
8072 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
8073 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8074 }
8075
8076 static void
8077 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8078 {
8079 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8080
8081 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
8082 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
8083 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8084 if (self->regex)
8085 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
8086 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
8087 }
8088
8089 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
8090
8091 /* Shared helper function (MI and CLI) for creating and installing
8092 a shared object event catchpoint. If IS_LOAD is non-zero then
8093 the events to be caught are load events, otherwise they are
8094 unload events. If IS_TEMP is non-zero the catchpoint is a
8095 temporary one. If ENABLED is non-zero the catchpoint is
8096 created in an enabled state. */
8097
8098 void
8099 add_solib_catchpoint (const char *arg, int is_load, int is_temp, int enabled)
8100 {
8101 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8102
8103 if (!arg)
8104 arg = "";
8105 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8106
8107 std::unique_ptr<solib_catchpoint> c (new solib_catchpoint ());
8108
8109 if (*arg != '\0')
8110 {
8111 c->compiled.reset (new compiled_regex (arg, REG_NOSUB,
8112 _("Invalid regexp")));
8113 c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
8114 }
8115
8116 c->is_load = is_load;
8117 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
8118 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
8119
8120 c->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8121
8122 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8123 }
8124
8125 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
8126 "catch unload". */
8127
8128 static void
8129 catch_load_or_unload (const char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
8130 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8131 {
8132 int tempflag;
8133 const int enabled = 1;
8134
8135 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8136
8137 add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, tempflag, enabled);
8138 }
8139
8140 static void
8141 catch_load_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8142 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8143 {
8144 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
8145 }
8146
8147 static void
8148 catch_unload_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8149 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8150 {
8151 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
8152 }
8153
8154 /* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind. If TEMPFLAG
8155 is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary. If COND_STRING is
8156 not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint. OPS, if not NULL, is
8157 the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint. */
8158
8159 void
8160 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8161 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
8162 const char *cond_string,
8163 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8164 {
8165 symtab_and_line sal;
8166 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
8167
8168 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
8169
8170 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
8171 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8172 }
8173
8174 void
8175 install_breakpoint (int internal, std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&arg, int update_gll)
8176 {
8177 breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (arg));
8178 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8179 if (is_tracepoint (b))
8180 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
8181 if (!internal)
8182 mention (b);
8183 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
8184
8185 if (update_gll)
8186 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8187 }
8188
8189 static void
8190 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8191 int tempflag, const char *cond_string,
8192 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8193 {
8194 std::unique_ptr<fork_catchpoint> c (new fork_catchpoint ());
8195
8196 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
8197
8198 c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
8199
8200 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8201 }
8202
8203 /* Exec catchpoints. */
8204
8205 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8206 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8207 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8208
8209 struct exec_catchpoint : public breakpoint
8210 {
8211 ~exec_catchpoint () override;
8212
8213 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8214 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8215 triggered. */
8216 char *exec_pathname;
8217 };
8218
8219 /* Exec catchpoint destructor. */
8220
8221 exec_catchpoint::~exec_catchpoint ()
8222 {
8223 xfree (this->exec_pathname);
8224 }
8225
8226 static int
8227 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8228 {
8229 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
8230 }
8231
8232 static int
8233 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8234 {
8235 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
8236 }
8237
8238 static int
8239 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
8240 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8241 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8242 {
8243 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8244
8245 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
8246 return 0;
8247
8248 c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
8249 return 1;
8250 }
8251
8252 static enum print_stop_action
8253 print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
8254 {
8255 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8256 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8257 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8258
8259 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8260 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8261 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8262 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8263 else
8264 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8265 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8266 {
8267 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
8268 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8269 }
8270 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
8271 uiout->text (" (exec'd ");
8272 uiout->field_string ("new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
8273 uiout->text ("), ");
8274
8275 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8276 }
8277
8278 static void
8279 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8280 {
8281 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8282 struct value_print_options opts;
8283 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8284
8285 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8286
8287 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8288 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8289 is relatively readable). */
8290 if (opts.addressprint)
8291 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8292 annotate_field (5);
8293 uiout->text ("exec");
8294 if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
8295 {
8296 uiout->text (", program \"");
8297 uiout->field_string ("what", c->exec_pathname);
8298 uiout->text ("\" ");
8299 }
8300
8301 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8302 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "exec");
8303 }
8304
8305 static void
8306 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8307 {
8308 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
8309 }
8310
8311 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8312 catchpoints. */
8313
8314 static void
8315 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8316 {
8317 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
8318 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8319 }
8320
8321 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
8322
8323 static int
8324 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8325 {
8326 int i = 0;
8327 struct breakpoint *b;
8328 struct bp_location *bl;
8329
8330 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8331 {
8332 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8333 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8334 {
8335 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8336 one register. */
8337 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8338 }
8339 }
8340
8341 return i;
8342 }
8343
8344 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8345 watchpoint. */
8346
8347 static int
8348 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
8349 {
8350 int i = 0;
8351 struct bp_location *bl;
8352
8353 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8354 return 0;
8355
8356 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8357 {
8358 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8359 one register. */
8360 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8361 }
8362
8363 return i;
8364 }
8365
8366 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8367 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8368 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8369 types _not_ TYPE. */
8370
8371 static int
8372 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
8373 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
8374 {
8375 int i = 0;
8376 struct breakpoint *b;
8377
8378 *other_type_used = 0;
8379 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8380 {
8381 if (b == except)
8382 continue;
8383 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8384 continue;
8385
8386 if (b->type == type)
8387 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
8388 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
8389 *other_type_used = 1;
8390 }
8391
8392 return i;
8393 }
8394
8395 void
8396 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8397 {
8398 struct breakpoint *b;
8399
8400 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8401 {
8402 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8403 {
8404 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
8405 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8406 }
8407 }
8408 }
8409
8410 void
8411 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8412 {
8413 struct breakpoint *b;
8414
8415 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8416 {
8417 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
8418 {
8419 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8420 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8421 }
8422 }
8423 }
8424
8425 void
8426 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
8427 {
8428 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
8429 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8430 }
8431
8432 void
8433 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
8434 {
8435 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
8436 breakpoint_re_set ();
8437 }
8438
8439 /* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
8440 locations. */
8441
8442 static struct breakpoint *
8443 new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
8444 {
8445 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b (new breakpoint ());
8446
8447 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bp_single_step,
8448 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8449
8450 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8451 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
8452
8453 b->thread = thread;
8454 gdb_assert (b->thread != 0);
8455
8456 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
8457 }
8458
8459 /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
8460 SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
8461 frame. */
8462
8463 breakpoint_up
8464 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
8465 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
8466 {
8467 struct breakpoint *b;
8468
8469 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
8470 tail-called one. */
8471 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
8472
8473 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8474 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8475 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8476 b->frame_id = frame_id;
8477
8478 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
8479
8480 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8481
8482 return breakpoint_up (b);
8483 }
8484
8485 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
8486 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
8487 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
8488
8489 static struct breakpoint *
8490 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
8491 enum bptype type,
8492 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8493 int loc_enabled)
8494 {
8495 struct breakpoint *copy;
8496
8497 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
8498 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
8499 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc, 1);
8500
8501 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
8502 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
8503 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
8504 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
8505 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
8506 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
8507 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
8508 copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
8509 copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
8510 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
8511 copy->thread = orig->thread;
8512 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
8513
8514 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8515 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8516 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
8517
8518 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8519 return copy;
8520 }
8521
8522 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
8523 ORIG is NULL. */
8524
8525 struct breakpoint *
8526 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
8527 {
8528 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
8529 if (orig == NULL)
8530 return NULL;
8531
8532 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
8533 }
8534
8535 breakpoint_up
8536 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
8537 enum bptype type)
8538 {
8539 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8540
8541 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
8542 sal.pc = pc;
8543 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
8544 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
8545
8546 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
8547 }
8548 \f
8549
8550 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
8551
8552 static void
8553 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
8554 {
8555 b->ops->print_mention (b);
8556 current_uiout->text ("\n");
8557 }
8558 \f
8559
8560 static int bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc);
8561
8562 static struct bp_location *
8563 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8564 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
8565 {
8566 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
8567 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
8568 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
8569
8570 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
8571 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
8572
8573 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
8574 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
8575 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
8576 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
8577 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
8578 location that's only been partially initialized. */
8579 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
8580 sal->pc, b->type);
8581
8582 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
8583 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
8584 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
8585 tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
8586 ;
8587 loc->next = *tmp;
8588 *tmp = loc;
8589
8590 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
8591 loc->address = adjusted_address;
8592 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
8593 loc->probe.prob = sal->prob;
8594 loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
8595 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
8596 loc->section = sal->section;
8597 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
8598 loc->line_number = sal->line;
8599 loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
8600 loc->symbol = sal->symbol;
8601 loc->msymbol = sal->msymbol;
8602 loc->objfile = sal->objfile;
8603
8604 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc,
8605 sal->explicit_pc || sal->explicit_line);
8606
8607 /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
8608 code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect
8609 that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program,
8610 thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing
8611 the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a
8612 SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the
8613 instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies
8614 with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the
8615 breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB
8616 breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed.
8617 (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint,
8618 it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint
8619 instruction.) */
8620 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
8621 loc->permanent = 1;
8622
8623 return loc;
8624 }
8625 \f
8626
8627 /* See breakpoint.h. */
8628
8629 int
8630 program_breakpoint_here_p (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
8631 {
8632 int len;
8633 CORE_ADDR addr;
8634 const gdb_byte *bpoint;
8635 gdb_byte *target_mem;
8636
8637 addr = address;
8638 bpoint = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &len);
8639
8640 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
8641 if (bpoint == NULL)
8642 return 0;
8643
8644 target_mem = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len);
8645
8646 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
8647 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
8648 breakpoints they are permanent. */
8649 scoped_restore restore_memory
8650 = make_scoped_restore_show_memory_breakpoints (0);
8651
8652 if (target_read_memory (address, target_mem, len) == 0
8653 && memcmp (target_mem, bpoint, len) == 0)
8654 return 1;
8655
8656 return 0;
8657 }
8658
8659 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
8660 return 0 otherwise. */
8661
8662 static int
8663 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
8664 {
8665 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
8666
8667 /* If we have a catchpoint or a watchpoint, just return 0. We should not
8668 attempt to read from the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types
8669 point to. program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read
8670 memory. */
8671 if (!breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (loc->owner))
8672 return 0;
8673
8674 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
8675 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
8676 return program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
8677 }
8678
8679 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
8680 settings of the dprintf style options. */
8681
8682 static void
8683 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
8684 {
8685 char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
8686 char *printf_line = NULL;
8687
8688 if (!dprintf_args)
8689 return;
8690
8691 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8692
8693 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
8694 insist on it. */
8695 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
8696 ++dprintf_args;
8697 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8698
8699 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
8700 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
8701
8702 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
8703 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8704 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
8705 {
8706 if (!dprintf_function)
8707 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
8708
8709 if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
8710 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
8711 dprintf_function,
8712 dprintf_channel,
8713 dprintf_args);
8714 else
8715 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
8716 dprintf_function,
8717 dprintf_args);
8718 }
8719 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
8720 {
8721 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
8722 printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
8723 else
8724 {
8725 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
8726 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8727 }
8728 }
8729 else
8730 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8731 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
8732
8733 gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
8734
8735 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
8736 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line
8737 = new struct command_line (simple_control, printf_line);
8738 breakpoint_set_commands (b, counted_command_line (printf_cmd_line,
8739 command_lines_deleter ()));
8740 }
8741
8742 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
8743 current style settings. */
8744
8745 static void
8746 update_dprintf_commands (const char *args, int from_tty,
8747 struct cmd_list_element *c)
8748 {
8749 struct breakpoint *b;
8750
8751 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8752 {
8753 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
8754 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8755 }
8756 }
8757
8758 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use LOCATION
8759 as a description of the location, and COND_STRING
8760 as condition expression. If LOCATION is NULL then create an
8761 "address location" from the address in the SAL. */
8762
8763 static void
8764 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8765 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8766 event_location_up &&location,
8767 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8768 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8769 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8770 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8771 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8772 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8773 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8774 int display_canonical)
8775 {
8776 int i;
8777
8778 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
8779 {
8780 int target_resources_ok;
8781
8782 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
8783 target_resources_ok =
8784 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
8785 i + 1, 0);
8786 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
8787 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
8788 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
8789 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
8790 }
8791
8792 gdb_assert (!sals.empty ());
8793
8794 for (const auto &sal : sals)
8795 {
8796 struct bp_location *loc;
8797
8798 if (from_tty)
8799 {
8800 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8801 if (!loc_gdbarch)
8802 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
8803
8804 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
8805 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
8806 }
8807
8808 if (&sal == &sals[0])
8809 {
8810 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
8811 b->thread = thread;
8812 b->task = task;
8813
8814 b->cond_string = cond_string.release ();
8815 b->extra_string = extra_string.release ();
8816 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
8817 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8818 b->disposition = disposition;
8819
8820 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8821 b->loc->inserted = 1;
8822
8823 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
8824 {
8825 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
8826 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
8827
8828 if (strace_marker_p (b))
8829 {
8830 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
8831 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
8832 const char *p
8833 = &event_location_to_string (b->location.get ())[3];
8834 const char *endp;
8835
8836 p = skip_spaces (p);
8837
8838 endp = skip_to_space (p);
8839
8840 t->static_trace_marker_id.assign (p, endp - p);
8841
8842 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8843 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8844 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8845 }
8846 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
8847 {
8848 t->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
8849
8850 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8851 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8852 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8853 }
8854 else
8855 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
8856 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
8857 }
8858
8859 loc = b->loc;
8860 }
8861 else
8862 {
8863 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
8864 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8865 loc->inserted = 1;
8866 }
8867
8868 if (b->cond_string)
8869 {
8870 const char *arg = b->cond_string;
8871
8872 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
8873 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
8874 if (*arg)
8875 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg);
8876 }
8877
8878 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
8879 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
8880 if (type == bp_dprintf)
8881 {
8882 if (b->extra_string)
8883 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8884 else
8885 error (_("Format string required"));
8886 }
8887 else if (b->extra_string)
8888 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
8889 }
8890
8891 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
8892 if (location != NULL)
8893 b->location = std::move (location);
8894 else
8895 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
8896 b->filter = filter.release ();
8897 }
8898
8899 static void
8900 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8901 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8902 event_location_up &&location,
8903 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8904 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8905 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8906 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8907 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8908 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8909 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8910 int display_canonical)
8911 {
8912 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type);
8913
8914 init_breakpoint_sal (b.get (), gdbarch,
8915 sals, std::move (location),
8916 std::move (filter),
8917 std::move (cond_string),
8918 std::move (extra_string),
8919 type, disposition,
8920 thread, task, ignore_count,
8921 ops, from_tty,
8922 enabled, internal, flags,
8923 display_canonical);
8924
8925 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
8926 }
8927
8928 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
8929 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
8930 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
8931 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
8932 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
8933 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
8934 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
8935 we take just a single condition string.
8936
8937 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
8938 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
8939 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
8940 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
8941 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
8942
8943 static void
8944 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8945 struct linespec_result *canonical,
8946 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8947 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8948 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8949 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8950 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8951 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
8952 {
8953 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
8954 gdb_assert (canonical->lsals.size () == 1);
8955
8956 for (const auto &lsal : canonical->lsals)
8957 {
8958 /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain
8959 'break', without arguments. */
8960 event_location_up location
8961 = (canonical->location != NULL
8962 ? copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ()) : NULL);
8963 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_string
8964 (lsal.canonical != NULL ? xstrdup (lsal.canonical) : NULL);
8965
8966 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal.sals,
8967 std::move (location),
8968 std::move (filter_string),
8969 std::move (cond_string),
8970 std::move (extra_string),
8971 type, disposition,
8972 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
8973 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
8974 canonical->special_display);
8975 }
8976 }
8977
8978 /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
8979 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
8980 addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for
8981 linespec locations).
8982
8983 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
8984 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
8985
8986 static void
8987 parse_breakpoint_sals (const struct event_location *location,
8988 struct linespec_result *canonical)
8989 {
8990 struct symtab_and_line cursal;
8991
8992 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
8993 {
8994 const char *spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
8995
8996 if (spec == NULL)
8997 {
8998 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default
8999 breakpoint address. */
9000 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9001 {
9002 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
9003 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
9004 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
9005 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
9006 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
9007 symtab_and_line sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
9008 CORE_ADDR pc = sal.pc;
9009
9010 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9011
9012 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
9013 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
9014 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
9015 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
9016 instances with the same symtab and line. */
9017 sal.pc = pc;
9018 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9019
9020 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9021 lsal.sals = {sal};
9022 lsal.canonical = NULL;
9023
9024 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
9025 return;
9026 }
9027 else
9028 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
9029 }
9030 }
9031
9032 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
9033 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
9034 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
9035 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
9036
9037 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
9038 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
9039 cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
9040 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9041 {
9042 const char *spec = NULL;
9043
9044 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9045 spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
9046
9047 if (!cursal.symtab
9048 || (spec != NULL
9049 && strchr ("+-", spec[0]) != NULL
9050 && spec[1] != '['))
9051 {
9052 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9053 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
9054 get_last_displayed_line (),
9055 canonical, NULL, NULL);
9056 return;
9057 }
9058 }
9059
9060 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9061 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
9062 }
9063
9064
9065 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
9066 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
9067
9068 static void
9069 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals)
9070 {
9071 for (auto &sal : sals)
9072 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
9073 }
9074
9075 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
9076 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
9077 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
9078 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
9079 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
9080 it, etc. */
9081
9082 static void
9083 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9084 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals)
9085 {
9086 for (const auto &sal : sals)
9087 {
9088 struct gdbarch *sarch;
9089
9090 sarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9091 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9092 associated with SAL. */
9093 if (sarch == NULL)
9094 sarch = gdbarch;
9095 std::string msg;
9096 if (!gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal.pc, &msg))
9097 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"),
9098 paddress (sarch, sal.pc), msg.c_str ());
9099 }
9100 }
9101
9102 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9103 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9104 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9105 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9106 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9107 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9108
9109 static void
9110 find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
9111 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
9112 char **rest)
9113 {
9114 *cond_string = NULL;
9115 *thread = -1;
9116 *task = 0;
9117 *rest = NULL;
9118
9119 while (tok && *tok)
9120 {
9121 const char *end_tok;
9122 int toklen;
9123 const char *cond_start = NULL;
9124 const char *cond_end = NULL;
9125
9126 tok = skip_spaces (tok);
9127
9128 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
9129 {
9130 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9131 return;
9132 }
9133
9134 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
9135
9136 toklen = end_tok - tok;
9137
9138 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
9139 {
9140 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
9141 parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
9142 cond_end = tok;
9143 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
9144 }
9145 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
9146 {
9147 const char *tmptok;
9148 struct thread_info *thr;
9149
9150 tok = end_tok + 1;
9151 thr = parse_thread_id (tok, &tmptok);
9152 if (tok == tmptok)
9153 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9154 *thread = thr->global_num;
9155 tok = tmptok;
9156 }
9157 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
9158 {
9159 char *tmptok;
9160
9161 tok = end_tok + 1;
9162 *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9163 if (tok == tmptok)
9164 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9165 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
9166 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
9167 tok = tmptok;
9168 }
9169 else if (rest)
9170 {
9171 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9172 return;
9173 }
9174 else
9175 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9176 }
9177 }
9178
9179 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9180
9181 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
9182 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p)
9183 {
9184 const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
9185 const char *endp;
9186
9187 p = skip_spaces (p);
9188
9189 endp = skip_to_space (p);
9190
9191 std::string marker_str (p, endp - p);
9192
9193 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
9194 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str.c_str ());
9195 if (markers.empty ())
9196 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"),
9197 marker_str.c_str ());
9198
9199 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
9200 sals.reserve (markers.size ());
9201
9202 for (const static_tracepoint_marker &marker : markers)
9203 {
9204 symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (marker.address, 0);
9205 sal.pc = marker.address;
9206 sals.push_back (sal);
9207 }
9208
9209 *arg_p = endp;
9210 return sals;
9211 }
9212
9213 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9214
9215 int
9216 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9217 const struct event_location *location,
9218 const char *cond_string,
9219 int thread, const char *extra_string,
9220 int parse_extra,
9221 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9222 int ignore_count,
9223 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9224 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9225 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9226 unsigned flags)
9227 {
9228 struct linespec_result canonical;
9229 int pending = 0;
9230 int task = 0;
9231 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9232
9233 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9234
9235 /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */
9236 if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0')
9237 extra_string = NULL;
9238
9239 TRY
9240 {
9241 ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical, type_wanted);
9242 }
9243 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9244 {
9245 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set
9246 value. */
9247 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
9248 {
9249 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9250 error. */
9251
9252 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9253 throw_exception (e);
9254
9255 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9256
9257 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9258 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9259 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9260 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9261 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9262 return 0;
9263
9264 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9265 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9266 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9267 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9268 pending = 1;
9269 }
9270 else
9271 throw_exception (e);
9272 }
9273 END_CATCH
9274
9275 if (!pending && canonical.lsals.empty ())
9276 return 0;
9277
9278 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9279 are ok for the target. */
9280 if (!pending)
9281 {
9282 for (auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9283 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (lsal.sals);
9284 }
9285
9286 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9287 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
9288 {
9289 for (const auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9290 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, lsal.sals);
9291 }
9292
9293 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9294 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9295 breakpoint. */
9296 if (!pending)
9297 {
9298 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_copy;
9299 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_copy;
9300
9301 if (parse_extra)
9302 {
9303 char *rest;
9304 char *cond;
9305
9306 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
9307
9308 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
9309 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
9310 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
9311 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
9312
9313 find_condition_and_thread (extra_string, lsal.sals[0].pc,
9314 &cond, &thread, &task, &rest);
9315 cond_string_copy.reset (cond);
9316 extra_string_copy.reset (rest);
9317 }
9318 else
9319 {
9320 if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf
9321 && extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0')
9322 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string);
9323
9324 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9325 if (cond_string)
9326 cond_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (cond_string));
9327 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9328 if (extra_string)
9329 extra_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (extra_string));
9330 }
9331
9332 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
9333 std::move (cond_string_copy),
9334 std::move (extra_string_copy),
9335 type_wanted,
9336 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
9337 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9338 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
9339 }
9340 else
9341 {
9342 std::unique_ptr <breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type_wanted);
9343
9344 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
9345 b->location = copy_event_location (location);
9346
9347 if (parse_extra)
9348 b->cond_string = NULL;
9349 else
9350 {
9351 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9352 b->cond_string = cond_string != NULL ? xstrdup (cond_string) : NULL;
9353 b->thread = thread;
9354 }
9355
9356 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9357 b->extra_string = extra_string != NULL ? xstrdup (extra_string) : NULL;
9358 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9359 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9360 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
9361 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9362 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
9363 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
9364 b->pspace = current_program_space;
9365
9366 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
9367 }
9368
9369 if (canonical.lsals.size () > 1)
9370 {
9371 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
9372 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
9373 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
9374 }
9375
9376 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9377
9378 return 1;
9379 }
9380
9381 /* Set a breakpoint.
9382 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
9383 condition, and thread.
9384 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
9385 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
9386 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
9387
9388 static void
9389 break_command_1 (const char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
9390 {
9391 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
9392 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
9393 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
9394 : bp_breakpoint);
9395 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
9396
9397 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9398
9399 /* Matching breakpoints on probes. */
9400 if (location != NULL
9401 && event_location_type (location.get ()) == PROBE_LOCATION)
9402 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
9403 else
9404 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
9405
9406 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9407 location.get (),
9408 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9409 tempflag, type_wanted,
9410 0 /* Ignore count */,
9411 pending_break_support,
9412 ops,
9413 from_tty,
9414 1 /* enabled */,
9415 0 /* internal */,
9416 0);
9417 }
9418
9419 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
9420
9421 void
9422 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9423 {
9424 CORE_ADDR pc;
9425
9426 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9427 {
9428 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
9429 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
9430 sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
9431 sal->pc = pc;
9432
9433 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
9434 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
9435 if (sal->explicit_line)
9436 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
9437 }
9438
9439 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9440 {
9441 const struct blockvector *bv;
9442 const struct block *b;
9443 struct symbol *sym;
9444
9445 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b,
9446 SYMTAB_COMPUNIT (sal->symtab));
9447 if (bv != NULL)
9448 {
9449 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
9450 if (sym != NULL)
9451 {
9452 fixup_symbol_section (sym, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
9453 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab),
9454 sym);
9455 }
9456 else
9457 {
9458 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
9459 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
9460 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
9461 happen in assembly source). */
9462
9463 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
9464 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
9465
9466 bound_minimal_symbol msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
9467 if (msym.minsym)
9468 sal->section = MSYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym.objfile, msym.minsym);
9469 }
9470 }
9471 }
9472 }
9473
9474 void
9475 break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9476 {
9477 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9478 }
9479
9480 void
9481 tbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9482 {
9483 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
9484 }
9485
9486 static void
9487 hbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9488 {
9489 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
9490 }
9491
9492 static void
9493 thbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9494 {
9495 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
9496 }
9497
9498 static void
9499 stop_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9500 {
9501 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
9502 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
9503 stop at <line>\n"));
9504 }
9505
9506 static void
9507 stopin_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9508 {
9509 int badInput = 0;
9510
9511 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
9512 badInput = 1;
9513 else if (*arg != '*')
9514 {
9515 const char *argptr = arg;
9516 int hasColon = 0;
9517
9518 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
9519 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
9520 function/method name. */
9521 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9522 {
9523 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9524 argptr++;
9525 }
9526
9527 if (hasColon)
9528 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
9529 else
9530 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
9531 }
9532
9533 if (badInput)
9534 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
9535 else
9536 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9537 }
9538
9539 static void
9540 stopat_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9541 {
9542 int badInput = 0;
9543
9544 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
9545 badInput = 1;
9546 else
9547 {
9548 const char *argptr = arg;
9549 int hasColon = 0;
9550
9551 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
9552 it is probably a line number. */
9553 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9554 {
9555 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9556 argptr++;
9557 }
9558
9559 if (hasColon)
9560 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
9561 else
9562 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
9563 }
9564
9565 if (badInput)
9566 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at LINE\n"));
9567 else
9568 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9569 }
9570
9571 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
9572 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
9573 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
9574 line. */
9575
9576 static void
9577 dprintf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9578 {
9579 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9580
9581 /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location;
9582 the next character must be ','. */
9583 if (arg != NULL)
9584 {
9585 if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0')
9586 error (_("Format string required"));
9587 else
9588 {
9589 /* Skip the comma. */
9590 ++arg;
9591 }
9592 }
9593
9594 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9595 location.get (),
9596 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9597 0, bp_dprintf,
9598 0 /* Ignore count */,
9599 pending_break_support,
9600 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
9601 from_tty,
9602 1 /* enabled */,
9603 0 /* internal */,
9604 0);
9605 }
9606
9607 static void
9608 agent_printf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9609 {
9610 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
9611 }
9612
9613 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
9614 ranged breakpoints. */
9615
9616 static int
9617 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
9618 const address_space *aspace,
9619 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
9620 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
9621 {
9622 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
9623 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
9624 return 0;
9625
9626 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
9627 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
9628 }
9629
9630 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
9631 ranged breakpoints. */
9632
9633 static int
9634 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
9635 {
9636 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9637 }
9638
9639 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
9640 ranged breakpoints. */
9641
9642 static enum print_stop_action
9643 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
9644 {
9645 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
9646 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9647 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9648
9649 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9650
9651 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9652 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9653
9654 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
9655
9656 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
9657
9658 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
9659 uiout->text ("Temporary ranged breakpoint ");
9660 else
9661 uiout->text ("Ranged breakpoint ");
9662 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9663 {
9664 uiout->field_string ("reason",
9665 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
9666 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
9667 }
9668 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
9669 uiout->text (", ");
9670
9671 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
9672 }
9673
9674 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
9675 ranged breakpoints. */
9676
9677 static void
9678 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9679 struct bp_location **last_loc)
9680 {
9681 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9682 struct value_print_options opts;
9683 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9684
9685 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9686 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9687
9688 get_user_print_options (&opts);
9689
9690 if (opts.addressprint)
9691 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
9692 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
9693 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
9694 annotate_field (5);
9695 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
9696 *last_loc = bl;
9697 }
9698
9699 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
9700 ranged breakpoints. */
9701
9702 static void
9703 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
9704 struct ui_out *uiout)
9705 {
9706 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
9707 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9708 string_file stb;
9709
9710 gdb_assert (bl);
9711
9712 address_start = bl->address;
9713 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
9714
9715 uiout->text ("\taddress range: ");
9716 stb.printf ("[%s, %s]",
9717 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
9718 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
9719 uiout->field_stream ("addr", stb);
9720 uiout->text ("\n");
9721 }
9722
9723 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
9724 ranged breakpoints. */
9725
9726 static void
9727 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9728 {
9729 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9730 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9731
9732 gdb_assert (bl);
9733 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9734
9735 uiout->message (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
9736 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
9737 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
9738 }
9739
9740 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
9741 ranged breakpoints. */
9742
9743 static void
9744 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
9745 {
9746 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s",
9747 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
9748 event_location_to_string (b->location_range_end.get ()));
9749 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
9750 }
9751
9752 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
9753
9754 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
9755
9756 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
9757 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
9758 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
9759 last instruction of the given line. */
9760
9761 static CORE_ADDR
9762 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
9763 {
9764 CORE_ADDR end;
9765
9766 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
9767 find the address of the end of the given location. */
9768 if (sal.explicit_pc)
9769 end = sal.pc;
9770 else
9771 {
9772 int ret;
9773 CORE_ADDR start;
9774
9775 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
9776 if (!ret)
9777 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9778
9779 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
9780 end--;
9781 }
9782
9783 return end;
9784 }
9785
9786 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
9787
9788 static void
9789 break_range_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9790 {
9791 const char *arg_start;
9792 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
9793 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
9794 CORE_ADDR end;
9795 struct breakpoint *b;
9796
9797 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
9798 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
9799 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
9800
9801 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9802 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9803 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9804 bp_count, 0);
9805 if (can_use_bp < 0)
9806 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9807
9808 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9809 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
9810 error(_("No address range specified."));
9811
9812 arg_start = arg;
9813 event_location_up start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9814 current_language);
9815 parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location.get (), &canonical_start);
9816
9817 if (arg[0] != ',')
9818 error (_("Too few arguments."));
9819 else if (canonical_start.lsals.empty ())
9820 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
9821
9822 const linespec_sals &lsal_start = canonical_start.lsals[0];
9823
9824 if (canonical_start.lsals.size () > 1
9825 || lsal_start.sals.size () != 1)
9826 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9827
9828 const symtab_and_line &sal_start = lsal_start.sals[0];
9829 std::string addr_string_start (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
9830
9831 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
9832 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9833
9834 /* Parse the end location. */
9835
9836 arg_start = arg;
9837
9838 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
9839 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
9840 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
9841 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
9842 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
9843 event_location_up end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9844 current_language);
9845 decode_line_full (end_location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9846 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
9847 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
9848
9849 if (canonical_end.lsals.empty ())
9850 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9851
9852 const linespec_sals &lsal_end = canonical_end.lsals[0];
9853 if (canonical_end.lsals.size () > 1
9854 || lsal_end.sals.size () != 1)
9855 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9856
9857 const symtab_and_line &sal_end = lsal_end.sals[0];
9858
9859 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
9860 if (sal_start.pc > end)
9861 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
9862
9863 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
9864 if (length < 0)
9865 /* Length overflowed. */
9866 error (_("Address range too large."));
9867 else if (length == 1)
9868 {
9869 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
9870 the `hbreak' command. */
9871 hbreak_command (&addr_string_start[0], 1);
9872
9873 return;
9874 }
9875
9876 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
9877 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
9878 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
9879 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
9880 b->number = breakpoint_count;
9881 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
9882 b->location = std::move (start_location);
9883 b->location_range_end = std::move (end_location);
9884 b->loc->length = length;
9885
9886 mention (b);
9887 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
9888 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9889 }
9890
9891 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
9892 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
9893 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
9894 zero. */
9895
9896 static int
9897 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
9898 {
9899 int i = exp->nelts;
9900
9901 while (i > 0)
9902 {
9903 int oplenp, argsp;
9904
9905 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
9906 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
9907 i -= oplenp;
9908
9909 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
9910 {
9911 case BINOP_ADD:
9912 case BINOP_SUB:
9913 case BINOP_MUL:
9914 case BINOP_DIV:
9915 case BINOP_REM:
9916 case BINOP_MOD:
9917 case BINOP_LSH:
9918 case BINOP_RSH:
9919 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
9920 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
9921 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
9922 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
9923 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
9924 case BINOP_EQUAL:
9925 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
9926 case BINOP_LESS:
9927 case BINOP_GTR:
9928 case BINOP_LEQ:
9929 case BINOP_GEQ:
9930 case BINOP_REPEAT:
9931 case BINOP_COMMA:
9932 case BINOP_EXP:
9933 case BINOP_MIN:
9934 case BINOP_MAX:
9935 case BINOP_INTDIV:
9936 case BINOP_CONCAT:
9937 case TERNOP_COND:
9938 case TERNOP_SLICE:
9939
9940 case OP_LONG:
9941 case OP_FLOAT:
9942 case OP_LAST:
9943 case OP_COMPLEX:
9944 case OP_STRING:
9945 case OP_ARRAY:
9946 case OP_TYPE:
9947 case OP_TYPEOF:
9948 case OP_DECLTYPE:
9949 case OP_TYPEID:
9950 case OP_NAME:
9951 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
9952
9953 case UNOP_NEG:
9954 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
9955 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
9956 case UNOP_ADDR:
9957 case UNOP_HIGH:
9958 case UNOP_CAST:
9959
9960 case UNOP_CAST_TYPE:
9961 case UNOP_REINTERPRET_CAST:
9962 case UNOP_DYNAMIC_CAST:
9963 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
9964 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
9965 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
9966 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
9967
9968 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
9969 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
9970 ADDR is. */
9971 break;
9972
9973 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
9974 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
9975
9976 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
9977 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
9978 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
9979 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
9980
9981 We also have to check for function symbols because they
9982 are always constant. */
9983 {
9984 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
9985
9986 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
9987 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
9988 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
9989 return 0;
9990 break;
9991 }
9992
9993 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
9994 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
9995 then it is not a constant. */
9996 default:
9997 return 0;
9998 }
9999 }
10000
10001 return 1;
10002 }
10003
10004 /* Watchpoint destructor. */
10005
10006 watchpoint::~watchpoint ()
10007 {
10008 xfree (this->exp_string);
10009 xfree (this->exp_string_reparse);
10010 }
10011
10012 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10013
10014 static void
10015 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10016 {
10017 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10018
10019 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10020 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10021
10022 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
10023 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
10024 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
10025 are loaded and unloaded.
10026
10027 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10028 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
10029 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
10030 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
10031 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
10032 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10033
10034 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10035 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
10036 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10037 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10038
10039 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10040 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10041
10042 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
10043 reevaluated again when enabled. */
10044 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
10045 }
10046
10047 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10048
10049 static int
10050 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10051 {
10052 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10053 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10054
10055 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10056 w->cond_exp.get ());
10057 }
10058
10059 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10060
10061 static int
10062 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10063 {
10064 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10065 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10066
10067 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10068 w->cond_exp.get ());
10069 }
10070
10071 static int
10072 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10073 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10074 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10075 {
10076 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
10077 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10078
10079 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10080 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10081 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10082 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10083 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10084 (did not match the data address). */
10085 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
10086 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
10087 return 0;
10088
10089 return 1;
10090 }
10091
10092 static void
10093 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10094 {
10095 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
10096
10097 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
10098 }
10099
10100 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10101 hardware watchpoints. */
10102
10103 static int
10104 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10105 {
10106 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10107 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
10108
10109 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
10110 }
10111
10112 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10113 hardware watchpoints. */
10114
10115 static int
10116 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10117 {
10118 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10119 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10120 }
10121
10122 static enum print_stop_action
10123 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10124 {
10125 struct breakpoint *b;
10126 enum print_stop_action result;
10127 struct watchpoint *w;
10128 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10129
10130 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
10131
10132 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10133 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10134
10135 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10136 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10137
10138 string_file stb;
10139
10140 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> tuple_emitter;
10141 switch (b->type)
10142 {
10143 case bp_watchpoint:
10144 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10145 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10146 uiout->field_string
10147 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10148 mention (b);
10149 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10150 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10151 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
10152 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10153 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10154 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10155 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10156 uiout->text ("\n");
10157 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10158 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10159 break;
10160
10161 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10162 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10163 uiout->field_string
10164 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10165 mention (b);
10166 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10167 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10168 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10169 uiout->field_stream ("value", stb);
10170 uiout->text ("\n");
10171 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10172 break;
10173
10174 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10175 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
10176 {
10177 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10178 uiout->field_string
10179 ("reason",
10180 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10181 mention (b);
10182 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10183 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10184 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
10185 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10186 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10187 }
10188 else
10189 {
10190 mention (b);
10191 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10192 uiout->field_string
10193 ("reason",
10194 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10195 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10196 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10197 }
10198 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10199 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10200 uiout->text ("\n");
10201 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10202 break;
10203 default:
10204 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10205 }
10206
10207 return result;
10208 }
10209
10210 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10211 watchpoints. */
10212
10213 static void
10214 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10215 {
10216 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10217 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10218 const char *tuple_name;
10219
10220 switch (b->type)
10221 {
10222 case bp_watchpoint:
10223 uiout->text ("Watchpoint ");
10224 tuple_name = "wpt";
10225 break;
10226 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10227 uiout->text ("Hardware watchpoint ");
10228 tuple_name = "wpt";
10229 break;
10230 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10231 uiout->text ("Hardware read watchpoint ");
10232 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10233 break;
10234 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10235 uiout->text ("Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10236 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10237 break;
10238 default:
10239 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10240 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10241 }
10242
10243 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10244 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
10245 uiout->text (": ");
10246 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10247 }
10248
10249 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10250 watchpoints. */
10251
10252 static void
10253 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10254 {
10255 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10256
10257 switch (b->type)
10258 {
10259 case bp_watchpoint:
10260 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10261 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10262 break;
10263 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10264 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10265 break;
10266 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10267 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10268 break;
10269 default:
10270 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10271 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
10272 }
10273
10274 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
10275 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10276 }
10277
10278 /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
10279 watchpoints. */
10280
10281 static int
10282 explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
10283 {
10284 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
10285 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
10286 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10287 return 0;
10288
10289 return 1;
10290 }
10291
10292 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
10293
10294 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10295
10296 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
10297 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10298
10299 static int
10300 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10301 {
10302 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10303
10304 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10305 bl->watchpoint_type);
10306 }
10307
10308 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
10309 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10310
10311 static int
10312 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10313 {
10314 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10315
10316 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10317 bl->watchpoint_type);
10318 }
10319
10320 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10321 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10322
10323 static int
10324 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10325 {
10326 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10327
10328 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
10329 }
10330
10331 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10332 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10333
10334 static int
10335 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10336 {
10337 return 0;
10338 }
10339
10340 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10341 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10342
10343 static enum print_stop_action
10344 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10345 {
10346 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10347 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10348
10349 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10350 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10351
10352 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10353 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10354
10355 switch (b->type)
10356 {
10357 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10358 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10359 uiout->field_string
10360 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10361 break;
10362
10363 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10364 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10365 uiout->field_string
10366 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10367 break;
10368
10369 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10370 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10371 uiout->field_string
10372 ("reason",
10373 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10374 break;
10375 default:
10376 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10377 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10378 }
10379
10380 mention (b);
10381 uiout->text (_("\n\
10382 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
10383 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
10384 uiout->text ("\n");
10385
10386 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10387 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10388 }
10389
10390 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10391 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10392
10393 static void
10394 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10395 struct ui_out *uiout)
10396 {
10397 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10398
10399 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10400 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10401
10402 uiout->text ("\tmask ");
10403 uiout->field_core_addr ("mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
10404 uiout->text ("\n");
10405 }
10406
10407 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10408 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10409
10410 static void
10411 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10412 {
10413 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10414 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10415 const char *tuple_name;
10416
10417 switch (b->type)
10418 {
10419 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10420 uiout->text ("Masked hardware watchpoint ");
10421 tuple_name = "wpt";
10422 break;
10423 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10424 uiout->text ("Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
10425 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10426 break;
10427 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10428 uiout->text ("Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10429 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10430 break;
10431 default:
10432 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10433 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10434 }
10435
10436 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10437 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
10438 uiout->text (": ");
10439 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10440 }
10441
10442 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10443 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10444
10445 static void
10446 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10447 {
10448 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10449 char tmp[40];
10450
10451 switch (b->type)
10452 {
10453 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10454 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10455 break;
10456 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10457 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10458 break;
10459 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10460 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10461 break;
10462 default:
10463 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10464 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10465 }
10466
10467 sprintf_vma (tmp, w->hw_wp_mask);
10468 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string, tmp);
10469 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10470 }
10471
10472 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
10473
10474 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10475
10476 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
10477
10478 static int
10479 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10480 {
10481 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10482 }
10483
10484 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
10485 hw_read: watch read,
10486 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
10487 static void
10488 watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
10489 int just_location, int internal)
10490 {
10491 struct breakpoint *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
10492 const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
10493 struct value *result;
10494 int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0;
10495 const char *exp_start = NULL;
10496 const char *exp_end = NULL;
10497 const char *tok, *end_tok;
10498 int toklen = -1;
10499 const char *cond_start = NULL;
10500 const char *cond_end = NULL;
10501 enum bptype bp_type;
10502 int thread = -1;
10503 int pc = 0;
10504 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
10505 the hardware watchpoint. */
10506 int use_mask = 0;
10507 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
10508
10509 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
10510 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
10511 {
10512 const char *value_start;
10513
10514 exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
10515
10516 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
10517 of the arguments string. */
10518 for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
10519 {
10520 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
10521 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10522 tok--;
10523
10524 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
10525 This is the value of the parameter. */
10526 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10527 tok--;
10528 value_start = tok + 1;
10529
10530 /* Skip whitespace. */
10531 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10532 tok--;
10533
10534 end_tok = tok;
10535
10536 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
10537 This is the parameter itself. */
10538 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10539 tok--;
10540 tok++;
10541 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
10542
10543 if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread"))
10544 {
10545 struct thread_info *thr;
10546 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
10547 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
10548 only in a specific thread. */
10549 const char *endp;
10550
10551 if (thread != -1)
10552 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
10553
10554 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
10555 thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp);
10556
10557 /* Check if the user provided a valid thread ID. */
10558 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
10559 invalid_thread_id_error (value_start);
10560
10561 thread = thr->global_num;
10562 }
10563 else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask"))
10564 {
10565 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
10566 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
10567 facility. */
10568 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
10569
10570 if (use_mask)
10571 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
10572
10573 use_mask = just_location = 1;
10574
10575 mark = value_mark ();
10576 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
10577 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
10578 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10579 }
10580 else
10581 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
10582 break;
10583
10584 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
10585 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
10586 exp_end = tok;
10587 }
10588 }
10589 else
10590 exp_end = arg;
10591
10592 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
10593 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
10594 ARG. */
10595 innermost_block.reset ();
10596 std::string expression (arg, exp_end - arg);
10597 exp_start = arg = expression.c_str ();
10598 expression_up exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
10599 exp_end = arg;
10600 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
10601 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
10602 prettier. */
10603 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
10604 --exp_end;
10605
10606 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
10607 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp.get ()))
10608 {
10609 int len;
10610
10611 len = exp_end - exp_start;
10612 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
10613 len--;
10614 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
10615 }
10616
10617 exp_valid_block = innermost_block.block ();
10618 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
10619 struct value *val_as_value = nullptr;
10620 fetch_subexp_value (exp.get (), &pc, &val_as_value, &result, NULL,
10621 just_location);
10622
10623 if (val_as_value != NULL && just_location)
10624 {
10625 saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val_as_value);
10626 saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val_as_value);
10627 }
10628
10629 value_ref_ptr val;
10630 if (just_location)
10631 {
10632 int ret;
10633
10634 exp_valid_block = NULL;
10635 val = release_value (value_addr (result));
10636 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10637
10638 if (use_mask)
10639 {
10640 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val.get ()),
10641 mask);
10642 if (ret == -1)
10643 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
10644 else if (ret == -2)
10645 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
10646 }
10647 }
10648 else if (val_as_value != NULL)
10649 val = release_value (val_as_value);
10650
10651 tok = skip_spaces (arg);
10652 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
10653
10654 toklen = end_tok - tok;
10655 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
10656 {
10657 innermost_block.reset ();
10658 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
10659 parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0);
10660
10661 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
10662 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
10663 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block.block ();
10664
10665 cond_end = tok;
10666 }
10667 if (*tok)
10668 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
10669
10670 frame_info *wp_frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
10671
10672 /* Save this because create_internal_breakpoint below invalidates
10673 'wp_frame'. */
10674 frame_id watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (wp_frame);
10675
10676 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
10677 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
10678 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
10679 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
10680 if (exp_valid_block != NULL && wp_frame != NULL)
10681 {
10682 frame_id caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (wp_frame);
10683
10684 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
10685 {
10686 gdbarch *caller_arch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (wp_frame);
10687 CORE_ADDR caller_pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (wp_frame);
10688
10689 scope_breakpoint
10690 = create_internal_breakpoint (caller_arch, caller_pc,
10691 bp_watchpoint_scope,
10692 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
10693
10694 /* create_internal_breakpoint could invalidate WP_FRAME. */
10695 wp_frame = NULL;
10696
10697 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
10698
10699 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
10700 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
10701
10702 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
10703 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = caller_frame_id;
10704
10705 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
10706 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch = caller_arch;
10707 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address = caller_pc;
10708 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
10709 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
10710 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
10711 scope_breakpoint->type);
10712 }
10713 }
10714
10715 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
10716 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
10717 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
10718 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
10719
10720 if (accessflag == hw_read)
10721 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
10722 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
10723 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
10724 else
10725 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10726
10727 std::unique_ptr<watchpoint> w (new watchpoint ());
10728
10729 if (use_mask)
10730 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10731 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10732 else
10733 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10734 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10735 w->thread = thread;
10736 w->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10737 w->pspace = current_program_space;
10738 w->exp = std::move (exp);
10739 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
10740 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
10741 if (just_location)
10742 {
10743 struct type *t = value_type (val.get ());
10744 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val.get ());
10745
10746 w->exp_string_reparse
10747 = current_language->la_watch_location_expression (t, addr).release ();
10748
10749 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
10750 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
10751 }
10752 else
10753 w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
10754
10755 if (use_mask)
10756 {
10757 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
10758 }
10759 else
10760 {
10761 w->val = val;
10762 w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos;
10763 w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize;
10764 w->val_valid = 1;
10765 }
10766
10767 if (cond_start)
10768 w->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
10769 else
10770 w->cond_string = 0;
10771
10772 if (frame_id_p (watchpoint_frame))
10773 {
10774 w->watchpoint_frame = watchpoint_frame;
10775 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
10776 }
10777 else
10778 {
10779 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
10780 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
10781 }
10782
10783 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
10784 {
10785 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
10786 need to act on them together. */
10787 w->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
10788 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w.get ();
10789 }
10790
10791 if (!just_location)
10792 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10793
10794 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
10795 that should be inserted. */
10796 update_watchpoint (w.get (), 1);
10797
10798 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (w), 1);
10799 }
10800
10801 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
10802 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
10803
10804 static int
10805 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals)
10806 {
10807 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
10808
10809 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
10810 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
10811 return 0;
10812
10813 gdb_assert (!vals.empty ());
10814 struct value *head = vals[0].get ();
10815
10816 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
10817 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
10818 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
10819 hardware watchpoint.
10820
10821 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
10822 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
10823 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
10824 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
10825 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
10826 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
10827 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
10828 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
10829 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
10830
10831 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
10832 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
10833 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
10834 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
10835 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : vals)
10836 {
10837 struct value *v = iter.get ();
10838
10839 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
10840 {
10841 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
10842 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
10843 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
10844 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
10845 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
10846 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
10847 ;
10848 else
10849 {
10850 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
10851 it with hardware watchpoints. */
10852 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
10853
10854 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
10855 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
10856 middle of some value chain. */
10857 if (v == head
10858 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
10859 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
10860 {
10861 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
10862 int len;
10863 int num_regs;
10864
10865 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
10866 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
10867 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
10868
10869 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
10870 if (!num_regs)
10871 return 0;
10872 else
10873 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
10874 }
10875 }
10876 }
10877 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
10878 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
10879 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
10880 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
10881 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
10882 }
10883
10884 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
10885 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
10886 return found_memory_cnt;
10887 }
10888
10889 void
10890 watch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10891 {
10892 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
10893 }
10894
10895 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
10896 calls watch_command_1. */
10897
10898 static void
10899 watch_maybe_just_location (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
10900 {
10901 int just_location = 0;
10902
10903 if (arg
10904 && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
10905 || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
10906 {
10907 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10908 just_location = 1;
10909 }
10910
10911 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
10912 }
10913
10914 static void
10915 watch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10916 {
10917 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
10918 }
10919
10920 void
10921 rwatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10922 {
10923 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
10924 }
10925
10926 static void
10927 rwatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10928 {
10929 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
10930 }
10931
10932 void
10933 awatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10934 {
10935 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
10936 }
10937
10938 static void
10939 awatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10940 {
10941 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
10942 }
10943 \f
10944
10945 /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands
10946 in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of
10947 breakpoints. */
10948
10949 struct until_break_fsm : public thread_fsm
10950 {
10951 /* The thread that was current when the command was executed. */
10952 int thread;
10953
10954 /* The breakpoint set at the destination location. */
10955 breakpoint_up location_breakpoint;
10956
10957 /* Breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame. May be
10958 NULL. */
10959 breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint;
10960
10961 until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread,
10962 breakpoint_up &&location_breakpoint,
10963 breakpoint_up &&caller_breakpoint)
10964 : thread_fsm (cmd_interp),
10965 thread (thread),
10966 location_breakpoint (std::move (location_breakpoint)),
10967 caller_breakpoint (std::move (caller_breakpoint))
10968 {
10969 }
10970
10971 void clean_up (struct thread_info *thread) override;
10972 bool should_stop (struct thread_info *thread) override;
10973 enum async_reply_reason do_async_reply_reason () override;
10974 };
10975
10976 /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the
10977 until(location)/advance commands. */
10978
10979 bool
10980 until_break_fsm::should_stop (struct thread_info *tp)
10981 {
10982 if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
10983 location_breakpoint.get ()) != NULL
10984 || (caller_breakpoint != NULL
10985 && bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
10986 caller_breakpoint.get ()) != NULL))
10987 set_finished ();
10988
10989 return true;
10990 }
10991
10992 /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the
10993 until(location)/advance commands. */
10994
10995 void
10996 until_break_fsm::clean_up (struct thread_info *)
10997 {
10998 /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */
10999 location_breakpoint.reset ();
11000 caller_breakpoint.reset ();
11001 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (thread);
11002 }
11003
11004 /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the
11005 until(location)/advance commands. */
11006
11007 enum async_reply_reason
11008 until_break_fsm::do_async_reply_reason ()
11009 {
11010 return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED;
11011 }
11012
11013 void
11014 until_break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
11015 {
11016 struct frame_info *frame;
11017 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
11018 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
11019 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
11020 int thread;
11021 struct thread_info *tp;
11022
11023 clear_proceed_status (0);
11024
11025 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
11026 this function. */
11027
11028 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
11029
11030 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals
11031 = (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()
11032 ? decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
11033 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
11034 get_last_displayed_line ())
11035 : decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11036 NULL, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0));
11037
11038 if (sals.size () != 1)
11039 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
11040
11041 symtab_and_line &sal = sals[0];
11042
11043 if (*arg)
11044 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11045
11046 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
11047
11048 tp = inferior_thread ();
11049 thread = tp->global_num;
11050
11051 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11052 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11053 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11054 that. */
11055
11056 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
11057 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
11058 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
11059 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11060
11061 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11062 one. */
11063
11064 breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint;
11065
11066 gdb::optional<delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup> lj_deleter;
11067
11068 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
11069 {
11070 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
11071 struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch;
11072
11073 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
11074 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11075 caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11076 caller_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch,
11077 sal2,
11078 caller_frame_id,
11079 bp_until);
11080
11081 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
11082 lj_deleter.emplace (thread);
11083 }
11084
11085 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11086 frame = NULL;
11087
11088 breakpoint_up location_breakpoint;
11089 if (anywhere)
11090 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
11091 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
11092 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11093 null_frame_id, bp_until);
11094 else
11095 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
11096 only at the very same frame. */
11097 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11098 stack_frame_id, bp_until);
11099
11100 tp->thread_fsm = new until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num,
11101 std::move (location_breakpoint),
11102 std::move (caller_breakpoint));
11103
11104 if (lj_deleter)
11105 lj_deleter->release ();
11106
11107 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT);
11108 }
11109
11110 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11111 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11112
11113 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11114 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11115 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11116 if clause in the arg string. */
11117
11118 const char *
11119 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (const char **arg)
11120 {
11121 const char *cond_string;
11122
11123 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
11124 return NULL;
11125
11126 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11127 (*arg) += 2;
11128
11129 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11130 condition string. */
11131 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
11132 cond_string = *arg;
11133
11134 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11135 string. */
11136 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
11137
11138 return cond_string;
11139 }
11140
11141 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11142 process start/exit, etc. */
11143
11144 typedef enum
11145 {
11146 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
11147 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
11148 }
11149 catch_fork_kind;
11150
11151 static void
11152 catch_fork_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11153 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11154 {
11155 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11156 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11157 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
11158 int tempflag;
11159
11160 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
11161 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
11162 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
11163
11164 if (!arg)
11165 arg = "";
11166 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11167
11168 /* The allowed syntax is:
11169 catch [v]fork
11170 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11171
11172 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11173 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11174
11175 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11176 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11177
11178 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11179 and enable reporting of such events. */
11180 switch (fork_kind)
11181 {
11182 case catch_fork_temporary:
11183 case catch_fork_permanent:
11184 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11185 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
11186 break;
11187 case catch_vfork_temporary:
11188 case catch_vfork_permanent:
11189 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11190 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
11191 break;
11192 default:
11193 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11194 break;
11195 }
11196 }
11197
11198 static void
11199 catch_exec_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11200 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11201 {
11202 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11203 int tempflag;
11204 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11205
11206 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11207
11208 if (!arg)
11209 arg = "";
11210 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11211
11212 /* The allowed syntax is:
11213 catch exec
11214 catch exec if <cond>
11215
11216 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11217 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11218
11219 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11220 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11221
11222 std::unique_ptr<exec_catchpoint> c (new exec_catchpoint ());
11223 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11224 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
11225 c->exec_pathname = NULL;
11226
11227 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
11228 }
11229
11230 void
11231 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11232 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11233 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11234 const char *addr_string,
11235 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11236 int tempflag,
11237 int enabled,
11238 int from_tty)
11239 {
11240 if (from_tty)
11241 {
11242 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
11243 if (!loc_gdbarch)
11244 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
11245
11246 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
11247 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
11248 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
11249 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
11250 used for different exception names will use the same address.
11251 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
11252 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
11253 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
11254 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
11255 enough for now, though. */
11256 }
11257
11258 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint, ops);
11259
11260 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
11261 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
11262 b->location = string_to_event_location (&addr_string,
11263 language_def (language_ada));
11264 b->language = language_ada;
11265 }
11266
11267 static void
11268 catch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11269 {
11270 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11271 }
11272 \f
11273
11274 static void
11275 tcatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11276 {
11277 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11278 }
11279
11280 /* Compare two breakpoints and return a strcmp-like result. */
11281
11282 static int
11283 compare_breakpoints (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
11284 {
11285 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) a;
11286 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) b;
11287
11288 if (a->number < b->number)
11289 return -1;
11290 else if (a->number > b->number)
11291 return 1;
11292
11293 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
11294 the number 0. */
11295 if (ua < ub)
11296 return -1;
11297 return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
11298 }
11299
11300 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
11301
11302 static void
11303 clear_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11304 {
11305 struct breakpoint *b;
11306 int default_match;
11307
11308 std::vector<symtab_and_line> decoded_sals;
11309 symtab_and_line last_sal;
11310 gdb::array_view<symtab_and_line> sals;
11311 if (arg)
11312 {
11313 decoded_sals
11314 = decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
11315 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
11316 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
11317 default_match = 0;
11318 sals = decoded_sals;
11319 }
11320 else
11321 {
11322 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
11323 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
11324 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
11325 last_sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
11326 if (last_sal.symtab == 0)
11327 error (_("No source file specified."));
11328
11329 default_match = 1;
11330 sals = last_sal;
11331 }
11332
11333 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
11334 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
11335 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
11336 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
11337
11338 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
11339 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
11340 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
11341 due to optimization, all in one block.
11342
11343 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
11344 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
11345 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
11346 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
11347 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
11348 to support that. */
11349
11350 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
11351 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
11352 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
11353 breakpoint. */
11354
11355 std::vector<struct breakpoint *> found;
11356 for (const auto &sal : sals)
11357 {
11358 const char *sal_fullname;
11359
11360 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
11361 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
11362 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
11363 or at default pc.
11364
11365 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
11366
11367 0 1 pc
11368 1 1 pc _and_ line
11369 0 0 line
11370 1 0 <can't happen> */
11371
11372 sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
11373 ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
11374
11375 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
11376 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11377 {
11378 int match = 0;
11379 /* Are we going to delete b? */
11380 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
11381 {
11382 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
11383 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
11384 {
11385 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
11386 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
11387 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
11388 && sal.pc
11389 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
11390 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
11391 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
11392 || loc->section == sal.section));
11393 int line_match = 0;
11394
11395 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
11396 && loc->symtab != NULL
11397 && sal_fullname != NULL
11398 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
11399 && loc->line_number == sal.line
11400 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
11401 sal_fullname) == 0)
11402 line_match = 1;
11403
11404 if (pc_match || line_match)
11405 {
11406 match = 1;
11407 break;
11408 }
11409 }
11410 }
11411
11412 if (match)
11413 found.push_back (b);
11414 }
11415 }
11416
11417 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
11418 if (found.empty ())
11419 {
11420 if (arg)
11421 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
11422 else
11423 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
11424 }
11425
11426 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
11427 std::sort (found.begin (), found.end (),
11428 [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
11429 {
11430 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) < 0;
11431 });
11432 found.erase (std::unique (found.begin (), found.end (),
11433 [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
11434 {
11435 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) == 0;
11436 }),
11437 found.end ());
11438
11439 if (found.size () > 1)
11440 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
11441 if (from_tty)
11442 {
11443 if (found.size () == 1)
11444 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
11445 else
11446 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
11447 }
11448
11449 for (breakpoint *iter : found)
11450 {
11451 if (from_tty)
11452 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", iter->number);
11453 delete_breakpoint (iter);
11454 }
11455 if (from_tty)
11456 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
11457 }
11458 \f
11459 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
11460 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
11461 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
11462
11463 void
11464 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
11465 {
11466 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
11467
11468 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
11469 if (bs->breakpoint_at
11470 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
11471 && bs->stop)
11472 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
11473
11474 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
11475 {
11476 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
11477 delete_breakpoint (b);
11478 }
11479 }
11480
11481 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
11482 qsort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
11483 does breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER),
11484 secondarily by ordering first permanent elements and
11485 terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted stable way despite
11486 qsort being an unstable algorithm. */
11487
11488 static int
11489 bp_locations_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
11490 {
11491 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
11492 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
11493
11494 if (a->address != b->address)
11495 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
11496
11497 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
11498 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
11499 grouped. */
11500
11501 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
11502 return ((a->pspace->num > b->pspace->num)
11503 - (a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num));
11504
11505 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
11506 if (a->permanent != b->permanent)
11507 return (a->permanent < b->permanent) - (a->permanent > b->permanent);
11508
11509 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
11510 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
11511 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
11512
11513 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
11514 return ((a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
11515 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number));
11516
11517 return (a > b) - (a < b);
11518 }
11519
11520 /* Set bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max and
11521 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
11522 content of the bp_locations array. */
11523
11524 static void
11525 bp_locations_target_extensions_update (void)
11526 {
11527 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
11528
11529 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
11530 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
11531
11532 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
11533 {
11534 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
11535
11536 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
11537 continue;
11538
11539 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
11540 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
11541
11542 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
11543 addr = bl->address - start;
11544 if (addr > bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
11545 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
11546
11547 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
11548
11549 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
11550 addr = end - bl->address;
11551 if (addr > bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max)
11552 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
11553 }
11554 }
11555
11556 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
11557
11558 static void
11559 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
11560 {
11561 struct breakpoint *b;
11562 enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN;
11563
11564 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
11565
11566 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
11567 {
11568 struct bp_location *bl;
11569 struct tracepoint *t;
11570 int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
11571
11572 if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
11573 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
11574 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
11575 continue;
11576
11577 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN)
11578 {
11579 if (target_can_download_tracepoint ())
11580 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE;
11581 else
11582 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE;
11583 }
11584
11585 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE)
11586 break;
11587
11588 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
11589 {
11590 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
11591 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
11592 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
11593 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
11594 continue;
11595
11596 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
11597
11598 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
11599
11600 bl->inserted = 1;
11601 bp_location_downloaded = 1;
11602 }
11603 t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
11604 t->number_on_target = b->number;
11605 if (bp_location_downloaded)
11606 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
11607 }
11608 }
11609
11610 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
11611
11612 static void
11613 swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
11614 {
11615 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
11616 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
11617 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
11618 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
11619
11620 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
11621 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
11622 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
11623 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
11624 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
11625
11626 left->inserted = right->inserted;
11627 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
11628 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
11629 left->target_info = right->target_info;
11630 right->inserted = left_inserted;
11631 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
11632 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
11633 right->target_info = left_target_info;
11634 }
11635
11636 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
11637 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
11638 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
11639 the target. */
11640
11641 static void
11642 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
11643 {
11644 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
11645 struct bp_location *loc;
11646 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
11647 int pspace_num;
11648
11649 address = bl->address;
11650 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
11651
11652 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
11653 evaluating conditions and if the user has
11654 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
11655 side. */
11656 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
11657 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
11658 return;
11659
11660 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
11661 the same program space as the location
11662 as "its condition has changed". We need to
11663 update the conditions on the target's side. */
11664 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, address)
11665 {
11666 loc = *loc2p;
11667
11668 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
11669 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
11670 continue;
11671
11672 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
11673 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
11674 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
11675 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
11676 that have already been marked. */
11677 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
11678
11679 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
11680 it later on. */
11681 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
11682 }
11683 }
11684 /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
11685 deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
11686 locations are duplicate of which.
11687
11688 The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
11689 shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
11690 info. */
11691
11692 static void
11693 update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
11694 {
11695 struct breakpoint *b;
11696 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
11697 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
11698 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
11699 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
11700 int last_pspace_num = -1;
11701
11702 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
11703 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
11704 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
11705 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
11706 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
11707 once. */
11708 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
11709 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
11710 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
11711 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
11712
11713 /* Saved former bp_locations array which we compare against the newly
11714 built bp_locations from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
11715 struct bp_location **old_locp;
11716 unsigned old_locations_count;
11717 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<struct bp_location *> old_locations (bp_locations);
11718
11719 old_locations_count = bp_locations_count;
11720 bp_locations = NULL;
11721 bp_locations_count = 0;
11722
11723 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11724 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11725 bp_locations_count++;
11726
11727 bp_locations = XNEWVEC (struct bp_location *, bp_locations_count);
11728 locp = bp_locations;
11729 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11730 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11731 *locp++ = loc;
11732 qsort (bp_locations, bp_locations_count, sizeof (*bp_locations),
11733 bp_locations_compare);
11734
11735 bp_locations_target_extensions_update ();
11736
11737 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
11738 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
11739 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
11740 if there's another location at the same address (previously
11741 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
11742 location.
11743
11744 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
11745 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
11746
11747 locp = bp_locations;
11748 for (old_locp = old_locations.get ();
11749 old_locp < old_locations.get () + old_locations_count;
11750 old_locp++)
11751 {
11752 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
11753 struct bp_location **loc2p;
11754
11755 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
11756 not, we have to free it. */
11757 int found_object = 0;
11758 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
11759 int keep_in_target = 0;
11760 int removed = 0;
11761
11762 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
11763 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
11764 while (locp < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11765 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
11766 locp++;
11767
11768 for (loc2p = locp;
11769 (loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11770 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
11771 loc2p++)
11772 {
11773 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
11774 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
11775 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
11776 place there. */
11777 if ((*loc2p)->condition_changed == condition_modified
11778 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
11779 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
11780 {
11781 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p);
11782 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
11783 }
11784
11785 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
11786 found_object = 1;
11787 }
11788
11789 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
11790 have to go through updates again. */
11791 last_addr = old_loc->address;
11792
11793 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
11794 if (!found_object)
11795 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
11796
11797 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
11798 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
11799 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
11800 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
11801 at certain location is not inserted. */
11802
11803 if (old_loc->inserted)
11804 {
11805 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
11806 it. */
11807
11808 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
11809 {
11810 /* The location is still present in the location list,
11811 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
11812 keep_in_target = 1;
11813 }
11814 else
11815 {
11816 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
11817 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
11818 remove its target-side condition. */
11819
11820 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
11821 disabled. See if there's another location at the
11822 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
11823 this one from the target. */
11824
11825 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
11826 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
11827 {
11828 for (loc2p = locp;
11829 (loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11830 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
11831 loc2p++)
11832 {
11833 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
11834
11835 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
11836 {
11837 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
11838 access watchpoints, if the former are not
11839 supported, but the latter are. */
11840 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
11841 {
11842 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
11843 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
11844 }
11845
11846 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
11847 if it should be inserted in case it will be
11848 unduplicated. */
11849 if (loc2 != old_loc
11850 && unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
11851 {
11852 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
11853 keep_in_target = 1;
11854 break;
11855 }
11856 }
11857 }
11858 }
11859 }
11860
11861 if (!keep_in_target)
11862 {
11863 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc))
11864 {
11865 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
11866 this location on the global list, and try to
11867 remove it next time, but there's no particular
11868 reason why we will succeed next time.
11869
11870 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
11871 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
11872 only after calling us. */
11873 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
11874 "breakpoint %d\n"),
11875 old_loc->owner->number);
11876 }
11877 removed = 1;
11878 }
11879 }
11880
11881 if (!found_object)
11882 {
11883 if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p ()
11884 && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc))
11885 {
11886 /* This location was removed from the target. In
11887 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
11888 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
11889 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
11890 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
11891 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
11892 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
11893 after we see some number of events. The theory here
11894 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
11895 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
11896 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
11897 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
11898 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
11899 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
11900 SIGTRAP.
11901
11902 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
11903 decr_pc_after_break targets.
11904
11905 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
11906 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
11907 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
11908 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
11909 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
11910 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
11911 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
11912 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
11913 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
11914 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
11915 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
11916 targets that do not support new thread events, like
11917 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
11918 thread_count.
11919
11920 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
11921 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
11922 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
11923 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
11924
11925 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
11926 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
11927 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
11928 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
11929 traps we can no longer explain. */
11930
11931 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
11932 old_loc->owner = NULL;
11933
11934 moribund_locations.push_back (old_loc);
11935 }
11936 else
11937 {
11938 old_loc->owner = NULL;
11939 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
11940 }
11941 }
11942 }
11943
11944 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
11945 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
11946 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
11947 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
11948 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
11949 are sorted first for the same address.
11950
11951 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
11952 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
11953
11954 bp_loc_first = NULL;
11955 wp_loc_first = NULL;
11956 awp_loc_first = NULL;
11957 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
11958 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
11959 {
11960 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
11961 non-NULL. */
11962 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
11963 b = loc->owner;
11964
11965 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
11966 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
11967 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
11968 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
11969 `struct bp_location'. */
11970 || is_tracepoint (b))
11971 {
11972 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
11973 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
11974 continue;
11975 }
11976
11977 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
11978 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
11979 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
11980 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
11981 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
11982 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
11983 else
11984 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
11985
11986 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
11987 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
11988 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
11989 {
11990 *loc_first_p = loc;
11991 loc->duplicate = 0;
11992
11993 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
11994 {
11995 loc->needs_update = 1;
11996 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
11997 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
11998 }
11999 continue;
12000 }
12001
12002
12003 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
12004 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
12005 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
12006 if (loc->inserted)
12007 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
12008 loc->duplicate = 1;
12009
12010 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12011 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12012 }
12013
12014 if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
12015 {
12016 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12017 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
12018 else
12019 {
12020 /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
12021 locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
12022 target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
12023 if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
12024 only update conditions for locations that are marked
12025 "needs_update". */
12026 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
12027 }
12028 }
12029
12030 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12031 download_tracepoint_locations ();
12032 }
12033
12034 void
12035 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
12036 {
12037 for (int ix = 0; ix < moribund_locations.size (); ++ix)
12038 {
12039 struct bp_location *loc = moribund_locations[ix];
12040 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
12041 {
12042 decref_bp_location (&loc);
12043 unordered_remove (moribund_locations, ix);
12044 --ix;
12045 }
12046 }
12047 }
12048
12049 static void
12050 update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12051 {
12052
12053 TRY
12054 {
12055 update_global_location_list (insert_mode);
12056 }
12057 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
12058 {
12059 }
12060 END_CATCH
12061 }
12062
12063 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12064
12065 static void
12066 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
12067 {
12068 bpstat bs;
12069
12070 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
12071 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
12072 {
12073 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
12074 bs->old_val = NULL;
12075 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12076 }
12077 }
12078
12079 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12080 static int
12081 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
12082 {
12083 struct breakpoint *bpt = (struct breakpoint *) data;
12084
12085 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
12086 return 0;
12087 }
12088
12089 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12090 callbacks. */
12091
12092 static void
12093 say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
12094 {
12095 struct value_print_options opts;
12096
12097 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12098
12099 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12100 single string. */
12101 if (b->loc == NULL)
12102 {
12103 /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based
12104 on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either
12105 a condition or dprintf arguments. */
12106 if (b->extra_string == NULL)
12107 {
12108 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."),
12109 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12110 }
12111 else if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
12112 {
12113 printf_filtered (_(" (%s,%s) pending."),
12114 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12115 b->extra_string);
12116 }
12117 else
12118 {
12119 printf_filtered (_(" (%s %s) pending."),
12120 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12121 b->extra_string);
12122 }
12123 }
12124 else
12125 {
12126 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
12127 {
12128 printf_filtered (" at ");
12129 fputs_styled (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
12130 address_style.style (),
12131 gdb_stdout);
12132 }
12133 if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
12134 {
12135 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12136 more nicely. */
12137 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
12138 {
12139 puts_filtered (": file ");
12140 fputs_styled (symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab),
12141 file_name_style.style (),
12142 gdb_stdout);
12143 printf_filtered (", line %d.",
12144 b->loc->line_number);
12145 }
12146 else
12147 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
12148 different file name, and this at least reflects the
12149 real situation somewhat. */
12150 printf_filtered (": %s.",
12151 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12152 }
12153
12154 if (b->loc->next)
12155 {
12156 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12157 int n = 0;
12158 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12159 ++n;
12160 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
12161 }
12162 }
12163 }
12164
12165 bp_location::~bp_location ()
12166 {
12167 xfree (function_name);
12168 }
12169
12170 /* Destructor for the breakpoint base class. */
12171
12172 breakpoint::~breakpoint ()
12173 {
12174 xfree (this->cond_string);
12175 xfree (this->extra_string);
12176 xfree (this->filter);
12177 }
12178
12179 static struct bp_location *
12180 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
12181 {
12182 return new bp_location (self);
12183 }
12184
12185 static void
12186 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12187 {
12188 /* Nothing to re-set. */
12189 }
12190
12191 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
12192 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
12193
12194 static int
12195 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12196 {
12197 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12198 }
12199
12200 static int
12201 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12202 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12203 {
12204 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12205 }
12206
12207 static int
12208 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12209 const address_space *aspace,
12210 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12211 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12212 {
12213 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12214 }
12215
12216 static void
12217 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
12218 {
12219 /* Always stop. */
12220 }
12221
12222 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12223 errors. */
12224
12225 static int
12226 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
12227 {
12228 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12229 }
12230
12231 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12232 errors. */
12233
12234 static int
12235 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12236 {
12237 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12238 }
12239
12240 static enum print_stop_action
12241 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
12242 {
12243 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12244 }
12245
12246 static void
12247 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12248 struct ui_out *uiout)
12249 {
12250 /* nothing */
12251 }
12252
12253 static void
12254 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12255 {
12256 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12257 }
12258
12259 static void
12260 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12261 {
12262 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12263 }
12264
12265 static void
12266 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
12267 (const struct event_location *location,
12268 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12269 enum bptype type_wanted)
12270 {
12271 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12272 }
12273
12274 static void
12275 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12276 struct linespec_result *c,
12277 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12278 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12279 enum bptype type_wanted,
12280 enum bpdisp disposition,
12281 int thread,
12282 int task, int ignore_count,
12283 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
12284 int from_tty, int enabled,
12285 int internal, unsigned flags)
12286 {
12287 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12288 }
12289
12290 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12291 base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12292 const struct event_location *location,
12293 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12294 {
12295 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12296 }
12297
12298 /* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
12299
12300 static int
12301 base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
12302 {
12303 return 1;
12304 }
12305
12306 /* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
12307
12308 static void
12309 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
12310 {
12311 /* Nothing to do. */
12312 }
12313
12314 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
12315 {
12316 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
12317 base_breakpoint_re_set,
12318 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
12319 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
12320 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
12321 base_breakpoint_check_status,
12322 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
12323 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
12324 base_breakpoint_print_it,
12325 NULL,
12326 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
12327 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
12328 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
12329 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location,
12330 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
12331 base_breakpoint_decode_location,
12332 base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
12333 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
12334 };
12335
12336 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
12337
12338 static void
12339 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12340 {
12341 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
12342 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
12343 {
12344 /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */
12345 delete_breakpoint (b);
12346 return;
12347 }
12348
12349 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12350 }
12351
12352 static int
12353 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12354 {
12355 CORE_ADDR addr = bl->target_info.reqstd_address;
12356
12357 bl->target_info.kind = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
12358 bl->target_info.placed_address = addr;
12359
12360 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12361 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12362 else
12363 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12364 }
12365
12366 static int
12367 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12368 {
12369 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12370 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12371 else
12372 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason);
12373 }
12374
12375 static int
12376 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12377 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12378 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12379 {
12380 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
12381 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
12382 return 0;
12383
12384 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
12385 aspace, bp_addr))
12386 return 0;
12387
12388 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
12389 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
12390 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
12391 return 0;
12392
12393 return 1;
12394 }
12395
12396 static int
12397 dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12398 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12399 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12400 {
12401 if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
12402 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
12403 {
12404 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
12405 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
12406 be set at the same address. */
12407 return 0;
12408 }
12409
12410 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
12411 }
12412
12413 static int
12414 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12415 {
12416 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
12417
12418 return 1;
12419 }
12420
12421 static enum print_stop_action
12422 bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12423 {
12424 struct breakpoint *b;
12425 const struct bp_location *bl;
12426 int bp_temp;
12427 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12428
12429 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
12430
12431 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
12432 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12433
12434 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
12435 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
12436 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
12437 bl->address,
12438 b->number, 1);
12439 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
12440 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
12441
12442 if (bp_temp)
12443 uiout->text ("Temporary breakpoint ");
12444 else
12445 uiout->text ("Breakpoint ");
12446 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12447 {
12448 uiout->field_string ("reason",
12449 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
12450 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
12451 }
12452 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
12453 uiout->text (", ");
12454
12455 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
12456 }
12457
12458 static void
12459 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12460 {
12461 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12462 return;
12463
12464 switch (b->type)
12465 {
12466 case bp_breakpoint:
12467 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
12468 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
12469 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
12470 else
12471 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
12472 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12473 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
12474 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
12475 break;
12476 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
12477 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
12478 break;
12479 case bp_dprintf:
12480 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
12481 break;
12482 }
12483
12484 say_where (b);
12485 }
12486
12487 static void
12488 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12489 {
12490 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12491 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
12492 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
12493 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
12494 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
12495 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12496 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
12497 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
12498 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
12499 else
12500 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12501 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
12502
12503 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12504 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()));
12505
12506 /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might
12507 contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */
12508 if (tp->loc == NULL && tp->extra_string != NULL)
12509 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->extra_string);
12510
12511 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12512 }
12513
12514 static void
12515 bkpt_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12516 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12517 enum bptype type_wanted)
12518 {
12519 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12520 }
12521
12522 static void
12523 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12524 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12525 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12526 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12527 enum bptype type_wanted,
12528 enum bpdisp disposition,
12529 int thread,
12530 int task, int ignore_count,
12531 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12532 int from_tty, int enabled,
12533 int internal, unsigned flags)
12534 {
12535 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12536 std::move (cond_string),
12537 std::move (extra_string),
12538 type_wanted,
12539 disposition, thread, task,
12540 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12541 enabled, internal, flags);
12542 }
12543
12544 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12545 bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12546 const struct event_location *location,
12547 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12548 {
12549 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12550 }
12551
12552 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
12553
12554 static void
12555 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12556 {
12557 switch (b->type)
12558 {
12559 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
12560 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
12561 case bp_overlay_event:
12562 case bp_longjmp_master:
12563 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12564 case bp_exception_master:
12565 delete_breakpoint (b);
12566 break;
12567
12568 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
12569 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
12570 case bp_shlib_event:
12571
12572 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
12573 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
12574 case bp_thread_event:
12575 break;
12576 }
12577 }
12578
12579 static void
12580 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12581 {
12582 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
12583 {
12584 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
12585 events. This allows the user to get control and place
12586 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
12587 objects (among other things). */
12588 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
12589 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
12590 }
12591 else
12592 bs->stop = 0;
12593 }
12594
12595 static enum print_stop_action
12596 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12597 {
12598 struct breakpoint *b;
12599
12600 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12601
12602 switch (b->type)
12603 {
12604 case bp_shlib_event:
12605 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
12606 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
12607 to shlib event" message.) */
12608 print_solib_event (0);
12609 break;
12610
12611 case bp_thread_event:
12612 /* Not sure how we will get here.
12613 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
12614 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12615 break;
12616
12617 case bp_overlay_event:
12618 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
12619 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12620 break;
12621
12622 case bp_longjmp_master:
12623 /* These should never be enabled. */
12624 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12625 break;
12626
12627 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12628 /* These should never be enabled. */
12629 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
12630 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12631 break;
12632
12633 case bp_exception_master:
12634 /* These should never be enabled. */
12635 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
12636 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12637 break;
12638 }
12639
12640 return PRINT_NOTHING;
12641 }
12642
12643 static void
12644 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12645 {
12646 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12647 }
12648
12649 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
12650
12651 static void
12652 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12653 {
12654 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
12655 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
12656 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
12657 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
12658 }
12659
12660 static void
12661 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12662 {
12663 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
12664 }
12665
12666 static enum print_stop_action
12667 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12668 {
12669 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
12670 }
12671
12672 static void
12673 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12674 {
12675 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12676 }
12677
12678 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
12679
12680 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
12681 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
12682
12683 longjmp_breakpoint::~longjmp_breakpoint ()
12684 {
12685 thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (this->thread);
12686
12687 if (tp != NULL)
12688 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
12689 }
12690
12691 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
12692
12693 static int
12694 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12695 {
12696 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
12697
12698 if (v == 0)
12699 {
12700 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
12701 if needed. */
12702 bl->probe.prob->set_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12703 }
12704
12705 return v;
12706 }
12707
12708 static int
12709 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12710 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12711 {
12712 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
12713 bl->probe.prob->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12714
12715 return bkpt_remove_location (bl, reason);
12716 }
12717
12718 static void
12719 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12720 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12721 enum bptype type_wanted)
12722 {
12723 struct linespec_sals lsal;
12724
12725 lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, NULL, canonical);
12726 lsal.canonical
12727 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
12728 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
12729 }
12730
12731 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12732 bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12733 const struct event_location *location,
12734 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12735 {
12736 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = parse_probes (location, search_pspace, NULL);
12737 if (sals.empty ())
12738 error (_("probe not found"));
12739 return sals;
12740 }
12741
12742 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
12743
12744 static void
12745 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12746 {
12747 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12748 }
12749
12750 static int
12751 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12752 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12753 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12754 {
12755 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
12756 tracepoints. */
12757 return 0;
12758 }
12759
12760 static void
12761 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12762 struct ui_out *uiout)
12763 {
12764 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12765 if (!tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
12766 {
12767 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
12768
12769 uiout->text ("\tmarker id is ");
12770 uiout->field_string ("static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
12771 tp->static_trace_marker_id);
12772 uiout->text ("\n");
12773 }
12774 }
12775
12776 static void
12777 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12778 {
12779 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12780 return;
12781
12782 switch (b->type)
12783 {
12784 case bp_tracepoint:
12785 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
12786 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12787 break;
12788 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
12789 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
12790 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12791 break;
12792 case bp_static_tracepoint:
12793 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
12794 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12795 break;
12796 default:
12797 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12798 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
12799 }
12800
12801 say_where (b);
12802 }
12803
12804 static void
12805 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
12806 {
12807 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12808
12809 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
12810 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
12811 else if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
12812 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
12813 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
12814 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
12815 else
12816 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12817 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
12818
12819 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12820 event_location_to_string (self->location.get ()));
12821 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
12822
12823 if (tp->pass_count)
12824 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
12825 }
12826
12827 static void
12828 tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12829 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12830 enum bptype type_wanted)
12831 {
12832 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12833 }
12834
12835 static void
12836 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12837 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12838 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12839 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12840 enum bptype type_wanted,
12841 enum bpdisp disposition,
12842 int thread,
12843 int task, int ignore_count,
12844 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12845 int from_tty, int enabled,
12846 int internal, unsigned flags)
12847 {
12848 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12849 std::move (cond_string),
12850 std::move (extra_string),
12851 type_wanted,
12852 disposition, thread, task,
12853 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12854 enabled, internal, flags);
12855 }
12856
12857 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12858 tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12859 const struct event_location *location,
12860 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12861 {
12862 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12863 }
12864
12865 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
12866
12867 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be use on tracepoints placed in a
12868 static probe. */
12869
12870 static void
12871 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
12872 (const struct event_location *location,
12873 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12874 enum bptype type_wanted)
12875 {
12876 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12877 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12878 }
12879
12880 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12881 tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12882 const struct event_location *location,
12883 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12884 {
12885 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12886 return bkpt_probe_decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
12887 }
12888
12889 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
12890
12891 /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
12892
12893 static void
12894 dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12895 {
12896 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12897
12898 /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */
12899 gdb_assert (b->extra_string != NULL);
12900
12901 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
12902 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
12903 3 - disconnect from target 1
12904 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
12905
12906 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
12907 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
12908 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
12909 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
12910 it all the time. */
12911 if (b->extra_string != NULL)
12912 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
12913 }
12914
12915 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
12916
12917 static void
12918 dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12919 {
12920 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s,%s",
12921 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()),
12922 tp->extra_string);
12923 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12924 }
12925
12926 /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
12927 dprintf.
12928
12929 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
12930 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
12931 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
12932 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
12933 address are all handled. */
12934
12935 static void
12936 dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
12937 {
12938 struct bpstats tmp_bs;
12939 struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs;
12940
12941 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
12942 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
12943 condition not be evaluated. */
12944 bs->stop = 0;
12945
12946 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
12947 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
12948 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
12949 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
12950 commands here throws. */
12951 tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands;
12952 bs->commands = NULL;
12953
12954 bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p);
12955
12956 /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
12957 bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
12958 list. */
12959 }
12960
12961 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
12962 markers (`-m'). */
12963
12964 static void
12965 strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12966 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12967 enum bptype type_wanted)
12968 {
12969 struct linespec_sals lsal;
12970 const char *arg_start, *arg;
12971
12972 arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
12973 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
12974
12975 std::string str (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
12976 const char *ptr = str.c_str ();
12977 canonical->location
12978 = new_linespec_location (&ptr, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
12979
12980 lsal.canonical
12981 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
12982 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
12983 }
12984
12985 static void
12986 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12987 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12988 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12989 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12990 enum bptype type_wanted,
12991 enum bpdisp disposition,
12992 int thread,
12993 int task, int ignore_count,
12994 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12995 int from_tty, int enabled,
12996 int internal, unsigned flags)
12997 {
12998 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical->lsals[0];
12999
13000 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
13001 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
13002 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
13003 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
13004 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
13005 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
13006
13007 for (size_t i = 0; i < lsal.sals.size (); i++)
13008 {
13009 event_location_up location
13010 = copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ());
13011
13012 std::unique_ptr<tracepoint> tp (new tracepoint ());
13013 init_breakpoint_sal (tp.get (), gdbarch, lsal.sals[i],
13014 std::move (location), NULL,
13015 std::move (cond_string),
13016 std::move (extra_string),
13017 type_wanted, disposition,
13018 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
13019 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
13020 canonical->special_display);
13021 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
13022 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
13023 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
13024 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
13025 try to match up which of the newly found markers
13026 corresponds to this one */
13027 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
13028
13029 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (tp), 0);
13030 }
13031 }
13032
13033 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13034 strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13035 const struct event_location *location,
13036 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13037 {
13038 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13039 const char *s = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
13040
13041 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
13042 if (sals.size () > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
13043 {
13044 sals[0] = sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
13045 sals.resize (1);
13046 return sals;
13047 }
13048 else
13049 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13050 }
13051
13052 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13053
13054 static int
13055 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
13056 {
13057 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13058 }
13059
13060 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13061 structures. */
13062
13063 void
13064 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13065 {
13066 struct breakpoint *b;
13067
13068 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
13069
13070 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13071 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13072 especial culprits.
13073
13074 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13075 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13076 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13077 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13078 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13079 deleted.
13080
13081 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13082 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13083 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13084 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13085 was chosen. */
13086 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
13087 return;
13088
13089 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13090 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13091 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
13092 {
13093 struct breakpoint *related;
13094 struct watchpoint *w;
13095
13096 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13097 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
13098 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13099 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
13100 else
13101 w = NULL;
13102 if (w != NULL)
13103 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
13104
13105 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
13106 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
13107 related = related->related_breakpoint);
13108 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
13109 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
13110 }
13111
13112 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
13113 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
13114 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
13115 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
13116 if (bpt->number)
13117 gdb::observers::breakpoint_deleted.notify (bpt);
13118
13119 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
13120 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
13121
13122 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13123 if (b->next == bpt)
13124 {
13125 b->next = bpt->next;
13126 break;
13127 }
13128
13129 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
13130 been freed. */
13131 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
13132 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
13133 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
13134 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
13135 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
13136 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
13137 commands won't work. */
13138
13139 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
13140
13141 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
13142 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
13143 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
13144 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
13145 might be better design to have location completely
13146 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
13147 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
13148
13149 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
13150 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
13151 bpt->type = bp_none;
13152 delete bpt;
13153 }
13154
13155 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
13156 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
13157
13158 static void
13159 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
13160 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13161 {
13162 struct breakpoint *related;
13163
13164 related = b;
13165 do
13166 {
13167 struct breakpoint *next;
13168
13169 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
13170 next = related->related_breakpoint;
13171
13172 if (next == related)
13173 {
13174 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
13175 function (related);
13176
13177 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
13178 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
13179 out. */
13180 break;
13181 }
13182 else
13183 function (related);
13184
13185 related = next;
13186 }
13187 while (related != b);
13188 }
13189
13190 static void
13191 delete_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
13192 {
13193 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13194
13195 dont_repeat ();
13196
13197 if (arg == 0)
13198 {
13199 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
13200
13201 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
13202 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
13203 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
13204 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13205 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13206 {
13207 breaks_to_delete = 1;
13208 break;
13209 }
13210
13211 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
13212 if (!from_tty
13213 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
13214 {
13215 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13216 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13217 delete_breakpoint (b);
13218 }
13219 }
13220 else
13221 map_breakpoint_numbers
13222 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
13223 {
13224 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
13225 });
13226 }
13227
13228 /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending. If
13229 PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are
13230 considered. */
13231
13232 static int
13233 all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13234 {
13235 struct bp_location *loc;
13236
13237 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
13238 if ((pspace == NULL
13239 || loc->pspace == pspace)
13240 && !loc->shlib_disabled
13241 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13242 return 0;
13243 return 1;
13244 }
13245
13246 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
13247 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
13248 Null names are ignored. */
13249
13250 static int
13251 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
13252 {
13253 struct bp_location *l;
13254 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string, streq_hash, NULL,
13255 xcalloc, xfree);
13256
13257 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
13258 {
13259 const char **slot;
13260 const char *name = l->function_name;
13261
13262 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
13263 if (name == NULL)
13264 continue;
13265
13266 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
13267 INSERT);
13268 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
13269 returns NULL. */
13270 if (*slot != NULL)
13271 {
13272 htab_delete (htab);
13273 return 1;
13274 }
13275 *slot = name;
13276 }
13277
13278 htab_delete (htab);
13279 return 0;
13280 }
13281
13282 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
13283 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
13284 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
13285 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
13286 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
13287 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
13288 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
13289 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
13290 The heuristic is:
13291
13292 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
13293 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
13294 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
13295 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
13296 in the sources, and output a warning.
13297
13298 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
13299 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
13300 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
13301 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
13302 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
13303 warning.
13304
13305 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
13306 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
13307 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
13308 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
13309 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
13310 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
13311 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
13312 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
13313 precisely because it confuses tools). */
13314
13315 static struct symtab_and_line
13316 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
13317 {
13318 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13319 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
13320 CORE_ADDR pc;
13321
13322 pc = sal.pc;
13323 if (sal.line)
13324 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
13325
13326 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
13327 {
13328 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id != marker.str_id)
13329 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
13330 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str (),
13331 marker.str_id.c_str ());
13332
13333 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
13334
13335 return sal;
13336 }
13337
13338 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
13339 by string ID. */
13340 if (!sal.explicit_pc
13341 && sal.line != 0
13342 && sal.symtab != NULL
13343 && !tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
13344 {
13345 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
13346 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid
13347 (tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13348
13349 if (!markers.empty ())
13350 {
13351 struct symbol *sym;
13352 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
13353 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13354 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
13355
13356 tpmarker = &markers[0];
13357
13358 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (tpmarker->str_id);
13359
13360 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
13361 "found at previous line number"),
13362 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13363
13364 symtab_and_line sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
13365 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
13366 uiout->text ("Now in ");
13367 if (sym)
13368 {
13369 uiout->field_string ("func", SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym),
13370 ui_out_style_kind::FUNCTION);
13371 uiout->text (" at ");
13372 }
13373 uiout->field_string ("file",
13374 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab),
13375 ui_out_style_kind::FILE);
13376 uiout->text (":");
13377
13378 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
13379 {
13380 const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
13381
13382 uiout->field_string ("fullname", fullname);
13383 }
13384
13385 uiout->field_int ("line", sal2.line);
13386 uiout->text ("\n");
13387
13388 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
13389 b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
13390
13391 b->location.reset (NULL);
13392 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13393 explicit_loc.source_filename
13394 = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
13395 explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number;
13396 explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE;
13397 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13398
13399 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
13400 so. */
13401 }
13402 }
13403 return sal;
13404 }
13405
13406 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
13407 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
13408
13409 static int
13410 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
13411 {
13412 while (a && b)
13413 {
13414 if (a->address != b->address)
13415 return 0;
13416
13417 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
13418 return 0;
13419
13420 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
13421 return 0;
13422
13423 a = a->next;
13424 b = b->next;
13425 }
13426
13427 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
13428 return 0;
13429
13430 return 1;
13431 }
13432
13433 /* Split all locations of B that are bound to PSPACE out of B's
13434 location list to a separate list and return that list's head. If
13435 PSPACE is NULL, hoist out all locations of B. */
13436
13437 static struct bp_location *
13438 hoist_existing_locations (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13439 {
13440 struct bp_location head;
13441 struct bp_location *i = b->loc;
13442 struct bp_location **i_link = &b->loc;
13443 struct bp_location *hoisted = &head;
13444
13445 if (pspace == NULL)
13446 {
13447 i = b->loc;
13448 b->loc = NULL;
13449 return i;
13450 }
13451
13452 head.next = NULL;
13453
13454 while (i != NULL)
13455 {
13456 if (i->pspace == pspace)
13457 {
13458 *i_link = i->next;
13459 i->next = NULL;
13460 hoisted->next = i;
13461 hoisted = i;
13462 }
13463 else
13464 i_link = &i->next;
13465 i = *i_link;
13466 }
13467
13468 return head.next;
13469 }
13470
13471 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software
13472 breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not
13473 zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint. Only recreates locations for
13474 FILTER_PSPACE. Locations of other program spaces are left
13475 untouched. */
13476
13477 void
13478 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
13479 struct program_space *filter_pspace,
13480 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
13481 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals_end)
13482 {
13483 struct bp_location *existing_locations;
13484
13485 if (!sals_end.empty () && (sals.size () != 1 || sals_end.size () != 1))
13486 {
13487 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
13488 location. */
13489 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13490 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
13491 "multiple locations found\n"),
13492 b->number);
13493 return;
13494 }
13495
13496 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
13497 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
13498 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
13499 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
13500 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
13501 individual locations. */
13502 if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.empty ())
13503 return;
13504
13505 existing_locations = hoist_existing_locations (b, filter_pspace);
13506
13507 for (const auto &sal : sals)
13508 {
13509 struct bp_location *new_loc;
13510
13511 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
13512
13513 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
13514
13515 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
13516 old symtab. */
13517 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
13518 {
13519 const char *s;
13520
13521 s = b->cond_string;
13522 TRY
13523 {
13524 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sal.pc,
13525 block_for_pc (sal.pc),
13526 0);
13527 }
13528 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
13529 {
13530 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
13531 "for breakpoint %d: %s"),
13532 b->number, e.message);
13533 new_loc->enabled = 0;
13534 }
13535 END_CATCH
13536 }
13537
13538 if (!sals_end.empty ())
13539 {
13540 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end[0]);
13541
13542 new_loc->length = end - sals[0].pc + 1;
13543 }
13544 }
13545
13546 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
13547 breakpoints. */
13548 {
13549 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
13550 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
13551 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
13552 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
13553 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
13554 often enough until a better solution is found. */
13555 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
13556
13557 for (; e; e = e->next)
13558 {
13559 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
13560 {
13561 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
13562 if (have_ambiguous_names)
13563 {
13564 for (; l; l = l->next)
13565 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l))
13566 {
13567 l->enabled = 0;
13568 break;
13569 }
13570 }
13571 else
13572 {
13573 for (; l; l = l->next)
13574 if (l->function_name
13575 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
13576 {
13577 l->enabled = 0;
13578 break;
13579 }
13580 }
13581 }
13582 }
13583 }
13584
13585 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
13586 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13587 }
13588
13589 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION.
13590 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
13591
13592 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13593 location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
13594 struct program_space *search_pspace, int *found)
13595 {
13596 struct gdb_exception exception = exception_none;
13597
13598 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
13599
13600 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
13601
13602 TRY
13603 {
13604 sals = b->ops->decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
13605 }
13606 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
13607 {
13608 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
13609
13610 exception = e;
13611
13612 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
13613 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
13614 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
13615 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
13616 state, then user already saw the message about that
13617 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
13618 errors. */
13619 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
13620 && (b->condition_not_parsed
13621 || (b->loc != NULL
13622 && search_pspace != NULL
13623 && b->loc->pspace != search_pspace)
13624 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
13625 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13626 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
13627 not_found_and_ok = 1;
13628
13629 if (!not_found_and_ok)
13630 {
13631 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
13632 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
13633 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
13634 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
13635 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
13636 which approach is better. */
13637 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13638 throw_exception (e);
13639 }
13640 }
13641 END_CATCH
13642
13643 if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
13644 {
13645 for (auto &sal : sals)
13646 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
13647 if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL)
13648 {
13649 char *cond_string, *extra_string;
13650 int thread, task;
13651
13652 find_condition_and_thread (b->extra_string, sals[0].pc,
13653 &cond_string, &thread, &task,
13654 &extra_string);
13655 gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL);
13656 if (cond_string)
13657 b->cond_string = cond_string;
13658 b->thread = thread;
13659 b->task = task;
13660 if (extra_string)
13661 {
13662 xfree (b->extra_string);
13663 b->extra_string = extra_string;
13664 }
13665 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
13666 }
13667
13668 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
13669 sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals[0]);
13670
13671 *found = 1;
13672 }
13673 else
13674 *found = 0;
13675
13676 return sals;
13677 }
13678
13679 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
13680 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
13681 locations. */
13682
13683 static void
13684 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
13685 {
13686 struct program_space *filter_pspace = current_program_space;
13687 std::vector<symtab_and_line> expanded, expanded_end;
13688
13689 int found;
13690 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location.get (),
13691 filter_pspace, &found);
13692 if (found)
13693 expanded = std::move (sals);
13694
13695 if (b->location_range_end != NULL)
13696 {
13697 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals_end
13698 = location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end.get (),
13699 filter_pspace, &found);
13700 if (found)
13701 expanded_end = std::move (sals_end);
13702 }
13703
13704 update_breakpoint_locations (b, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end);
13705 }
13706
13707 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
13708 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
13709
13710 static void
13711 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
13712 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13713 enum bptype type_wanted)
13714 {
13715 parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical);
13716 }
13717
13718 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
13719 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
13720 breakpoint_ops. */
13721
13722 static void
13723 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13724 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13725 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13726 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13727 enum bptype type_wanted,
13728 enum bpdisp disposition,
13729 int thread,
13730 int task, int ignore_count,
13731 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13732 int from_tty, int enabled,
13733 int internal, unsigned flags)
13734 {
13735 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical,
13736 std::move (cond_string),
13737 std::move (extra_string),
13738 type_wanted, disposition,
13739 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13740 enabled, internal, flags);
13741 }
13742
13743 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
13744 default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */
13745
13746 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13747 decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
13748 const struct event_location *location,
13749 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13750 {
13751 struct linespec_result canonical;
13752
13753 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace,
13754 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
13755 &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
13756 b->filter);
13757
13758 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
13759 gdb_assert (canonical.lsals.size () < 2);
13760
13761 if (!canonical.lsals.empty ())
13762 {
13763 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
13764 return std::move (lsal.sals);
13765 }
13766 return {};
13767 }
13768
13769 /* Reset a breakpoint. */
13770
13771 static void
13772 breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint *b)
13773 {
13774 input_radix = b->input_radix;
13775 set_language (b->language);
13776
13777 b->ops->re_set (b);
13778 }
13779
13780 /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space.
13781 Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched. */
13782
13783 void
13784 breakpoint_re_set (void)
13785 {
13786 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13787
13788 {
13789 scoped_restore_current_language save_language;
13790 scoped_restore save_input_radix = make_scoped_restore (&input_radix);
13791 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
13792
13793 /* breakpoint_re_set_one sets the current_language to the language
13794 of the breakpoint it is resetting (see prepare_re_set_context)
13795 before re-evaluating the breakpoint's location. This change can
13796 unfortunately get undone by accident if the language_mode is set
13797 to auto, and we either switch frames, or more likely in this context,
13798 we select the current frame.
13799
13800 We prevent this by temporarily turning the language_mode to
13801 language_mode_manual. We restore it once all breakpoints
13802 have been reset. */
13803 scoped_restore save_language_mode = make_scoped_restore (&language_mode);
13804 language_mode = language_mode_manual;
13805
13806 /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all
13807 breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting
13808 breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which
13809 hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */
13810
13811 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13812 {
13813 TRY
13814 {
13815 breakpoint_re_set_one (b);
13816 }
13817 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
13818 {
13819 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
13820 "Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
13821 b->number);
13822 }
13823 END_CATCH
13824 }
13825
13826 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
13827 }
13828
13829 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
13830 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
13831 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
13832 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
13833
13834 /* Now we can insert. */
13835 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
13836 }
13837 \f
13838 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
13839
13840 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
13841 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
13842 void
13843 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
13844 {
13845 if (b->thread != -1)
13846 {
13847 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
13848
13849 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
13850 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
13851 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
13852 as well. */
13853 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
13854 }
13855 }
13856
13857 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
13858 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
13859 which ends with a period (no newline). */
13860
13861 void
13862 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
13863 {
13864 struct breakpoint *b;
13865
13866 if (count < 0)
13867 count = 0;
13868
13869 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13870 if (b->number == bptnum)
13871 {
13872 if (is_tracepoint (b))
13873 {
13874 if (from_tty && count != 0)
13875 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
13876 bptnum);
13877 return;
13878 }
13879
13880 b->ignore_count = count;
13881 if (from_tty)
13882 {
13883 if (count == 0)
13884 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
13885 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
13886 bptnum);
13887 else if (count == 1)
13888 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
13889 bptnum);
13890 else
13891 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
13892 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
13893 count, bptnum);
13894 }
13895 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13896 return;
13897 }
13898
13899 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
13900 }
13901
13902 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
13903
13904 static void
13905 ignore_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
13906 {
13907 const char *p = args;
13908 int num;
13909
13910 if (p == 0)
13911 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
13912
13913 num = get_number (&p);
13914 if (num == 0)
13915 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
13916 if (*p == 0)
13917 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
13918
13919 set_ignore_count (num,
13920 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
13921 from_tty);
13922 if (from_tty)
13923 printf_filtered ("\n");
13924 }
13925 \f
13926
13927 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints with numbers in the range
13928 defined by BP_NUM_RANGE (an inclusive range). */
13929
13930 static void
13931 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range,
13932 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13933 {
13934 if (bp_num_range.first == 0)
13935 {
13936 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%d'"),
13937 bp_num_range.first);
13938 }
13939 else
13940 {
13941 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
13942
13943 for (int i = bp_num_range.first; i <= bp_num_range.second; i++)
13944 {
13945 bool match = false;
13946
13947 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
13948 if (b->number == i)
13949 {
13950 match = true;
13951 function (b);
13952 break;
13953 }
13954 if (!match)
13955 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), i);
13956 }
13957 }
13958 }
13959
13960 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints whose numbers are given in
13961 ARGS. */
13962
13963 static void
13964 map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args,
13965 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13966 {
13967 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
13968 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
13969
13970 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
13971
13972 while (!parser.finished ())
13973 {
13974 int num = parser.get_number ();
13975 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::make_pair (num, num), function);
13976 }
13977 }
13978
13979 /* Return the breakpoint location structure corresponding to the
13980 BP_NUM and LOC_NUM values. */
13981
13982 static struct bp_location *
13983 find_location_by_number (int bp_num, int loc_num)
13984 {
13985 struct breakpoint *b;
13986
13987 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13988 if (b->number == bp_num)
13989 {
13990 break;
13991 }
13992
13993 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
13994 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%d'"), bp_num);
13995
13996 if (loc_num == 0)
13997 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
13998
13999 int n = 0;
14000 for (bp_location *loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14001 if (++n == loc_num)
14002 return loc;
14003
14004 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
14005 }
14006
14007 /* Modes of operation for extract_bp_num. */
14008 enum class extract_bp_kind
14009 {
14010 /* Extracting a breakpoint number. */
14011 bp,
14012
14013 /* Extracting a location number. */
14014 loc,
14015 };
14016
14017 /* Extract a breakpoint or location number (as determined by KIND)
14018 from the string starting at START. TRAILER is a character which
14019 can be found after the number. If you don't want a trailer, use
14020 '\0'. If END_OUT is not NULL, it is set to point after the parsed
14021 string. This always returns a positive integer. */
14022
14023 static int
14024 extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind kind, const char *start,
14025 int trailer, const char **end_out = NULL)
14026 {
14027 const char *end = start;
14028 int num = get_number_trailer (&end, trailer);
14029 if (num < 0)
14030 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14031 ? _("Negative breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14032 : _("Negative breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14033 int (end - start), start);
14034 if (num == 0)
14035 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14036 ? _("Bad breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14037 : _("Bad breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14038 int (end - start), start);
14039
14040 if (end_out != NULL)
14041 *end_out = end;
14042 return num;
14043 }
14044
14045 /* Extract a breakpoint or location range (as determined by KIND) in
14046 the form NUM1-NUM2 stored at &ARG[arg_offset]. Returns a std::pair
14047 representing the (inclusive) range. The returned pair's elements
14048 are always positive integers. */
14049
14050 static std::pair<int, int>
14051 extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind kind,
14052 const std::string &arg,
14053 std::string::size_type arg_offset)
14054 {
14055 std::pair<int, int> range;
14056 const char *bp_loc = &arg[arg_offset];
14057 std::string::size_type dash = arg.find ('-', arg_offset);
14058 if (dash != std::string::npos)
14059 {
14060 /* bp_loc is a range (x-z). */
14061 if (arg.length () == dash + 1)
14062 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14063 ? _("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'")
14064 : _("Bad breakpoint location number at or near: '%s'"),
14065 bp_loc);
14066
14067 const char *end;
14068 const char *start_first = bp_loc;
14069 const char *start_second = &arg[dash + 1];
14070 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, start_first, '-');
14071 range.second = extract_bp_num (kind, start_second, '\0', &end);
14072
14073 if (range.first > range.second)
14074 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14075 ? _("Inverted breakpoint range at '%.*s'")
14076 : _("Inverted breakpoint location range at '%.*s'"),
14077 int (end - start_first), start_first);
14078 }
14079 else
14080 {
14081 /* bp_loc is a single value. */
14082 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, bp_loc, '\0');
14083 range.second = range.first;
14084 }
14085 return range;
14086 }
14087
14088 /* Extract the breakpoint/location range specified by ARG. Returns
14089 the breakpoint range in BP_NUM_RANGE, and the location range in
14090 BP_LOC_RANGE.
14091
14092 ARG may be in any of the following forms:
14093
14094 x where 'x' is a breakpoint number.
14095 x-y where 'x' and 'y' specify a breakpoint numbers range.
14096 x.y where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' a location number.
14097 x.y-z where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' and 'z' specify a
14098 location number range.
14099 */
14100
14101 static void
14102 extract_bp_number_and_location (const std::string &arg,
14103 std::pair<int, int> &bp_num_range,
14104 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range)
14105 {
14106 std::string::size_type dot = arg.find ('.');
14107
14108 if (dot != std::string::npos)
14109 {
14110 /* Handle 'x.y' and 'x.y-z' cases. */
14111
14112 if (arg.length () == dot + 1 || dot == 0)
14113 error (_("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'"), arg.c_str ());
14114
14115 bp_num_range.first
14116 = extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg.c_str (), '.');
14117 bp_num_range.second = bp_num_range.first;
14118
14119 bp_loc_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::loc,
14120 arg, dot + 1);
14121 }
14122 else
14123 {
14124 /* Handle x and x-y cases. */
14125
14126 bp_num_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg, 0);
14127 bp_loc_range.first = 0;
14128 bp_loc_range.second = 0;
14129 }
14130 }
14131
14132 /* Enable or disable a breakpoint location BP_NUM.LOC_NUM. ENABLE
14133 specifies whether to enable or disable. */
14134
14135 static void
14136 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (int bp_num, int loc_num, bool enable)
14137 {
14138 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (bp_num, loc_num);
14139 if (loc != NULL)
14140 {
14141 if (loc->enabled != enable)
14142 {
14143 loc->enabled = enable;
14144 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14145 }
14146 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14147 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14148 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14149 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
14150 }
14151 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14152
14153 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (loc->owner);
14154 }
14155
14156 /* Enable or disable a range of breakpoint locations. BP_NUM is the
14157 number of the breakpoint, and BP_LOC_RANGE specifies the
14158 (inclusive) range of location numbers of that breakpoint to
14159 enable/disable. ENABLE specifies whether to enable or disable the
14160 location. */
14161
14162 static void
14163 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range (int bp_num,
14164 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range,
14165 bool enable)
14166 {
14167 for (int i = bp_loc_range.first; i <= bp_loc_range.second; i++)
14168 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (bp_num, i, enable);
14169 }
14170
14171 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14172 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14173 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14174
14175 void
14176 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14177 {
14178 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14179 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14180 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14181 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14182 return;
14183
14184 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14185
14186 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14187 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14188
14189 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14190 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14191 {
14192 struct bp_location *location;
14193
14194 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14195 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
14196 }
14197
14198 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14199
14200 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
14201 }
14202
14203 /* Enable or disable the breakpoint(s) or breakpoint location(s)
14204 specified in ARGS. ARGS may be in any of the formats handled by
14205 extract_bp_number_and_location. ENABLE specifies whether to enable
14206 or disable the breakpoints/locations. */
14207
14208 static void
14209 enable_disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty, bool enable)
14210 {
14211 if (args == 0)
14212 {
14213 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14214
14215 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14216 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14217 {
14218 if (enable)
14219 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
14220 else
14221 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
14222 }
14223 }
14224 else
14225 {
14226 std::string num = extract_arg (&args);
14227
14228 while (!num.empty ())
14229 {
14230 std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, bp_loc_range;
14231
14232 extract_bp_number_and_location (num, bp_num_range, bp_loc_range);
14233
14234 if (bp_loc_range.first == bp_loc_range.second
14235 && bp_loc_range.first == 0)
14236 {
14237 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x' or 'x-z'. */
14238 map_breakpoint_number_range (bp_num_range,
14239 enable
14240 ? enable_breakpoint
14241 : disable_breakpoint);
14242 }
14243 else
14244 {
14245 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x.y' or
14246 'x.y-z'. */
14247 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range
14248 (bp_num_range.first, bp_loc_range, enable);
14249 }
14250 num = extract_arg (&args);
14251 }
14252 }
14253 }
14254
14255 /* The disable command disables the specified breakpoints/locations
14256 (or all defined breakpoints) so they're no longer effective in
14257 stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the forms defined in
14258 extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14259
14260 static void
14261 disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14262 {
14263 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, false);
14264 }
14265
14266 static void
14267 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
14268 int count)
14269 {
14270 int target_resources_ok;
14271
14272 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
14273 {
14274 int i;
14275 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
14276 target_resources_ok =
14277 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
14278 i + 1, 0);
14279 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
14280 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
14281 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
14282 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
14283 }
14284
14285 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
14286 {
14287 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
14288 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled;
14289
14290 TRY
14291 {
14292 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
14293
14294 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
14295 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14296 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
14297 }
14298 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
14299 {
14300 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
14301 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
14302 bpt->number);
14303 return;
14304 }
14305 END_CATCH
14306 }
14307
14308 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14309
14310 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14311 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14312
14313 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14314 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14315 {
14316 struct bp_location *location;
14317
14318 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14319 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
14320 }
14321
14322 bpt->disposition = disposition;
14323 bpt->enable_count = count;
14324 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14325
14326 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
14327 }
14328
14329
14330 void
14331 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14332 {
14333 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
14334 }
14335
14336 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints/locations (or
14337 all defined breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to
14338 be) effective in stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the
14339 forms defined in extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14340
14341 static void
14342 enable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14343 {
14344 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, true);
14345 }
14346
14347 static void
14348 enable_once_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14349 {
14350 map_breakpoint_numbers
14351 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14352 {
14353 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14354 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14355 {
14356 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, 1);
14357 });
14358 });
14359 }
14360
14361 static void
14362 enable_count_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14363 {
14364 int count;
14365
14366 if (args == NULL)
14367 error_no_arg (_("hit count"));
14368
14369 count = get_number (&args);
14370
14371 map_breakpoint_numbers
14372 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14373 {
14374 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14375 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14376 {
14377 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, count);
14378 });
14379 });
14380 }
14381
14382 static void
14383 enable_delete_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14384 {
14385 map_breakpoint_numbers
14386 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14387 {
14388 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14389 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14390 {
14391 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_del, 1);
14392 });
14393 });
14394 }
14395 \f
14396 static void
14397 set_breakpoint_cmd (const char *args, int from_tty)
14398 {
14399 }
14400
14401 static void
14402 show_breakpoint_cmd (const char *args, int from_tty)
14403 {
14404 }
14405
14406 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
14407 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
14408 GDB itself. */
14409
14410 static void
14411 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
14412 CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
14413 const bfd_byte *data)
14414 {
14415 struct breakpoint *bp;
14416
14417 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
14418 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
14419 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
14420 {
14421 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
14422
14423 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val != nullptr)
14424 {
14425 struct bp_location *loc;
14426
14427 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14428 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
14429 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
14430 && addr + len > loc->address)
14431 {
14432 wp->val = NULL;
14433 wp->val_valid = 0;
14434 }
14435 }
14436 }
14437 }
14438
14439 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
14440
14441 void
14442 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14443 const address_space *aspace,
14444 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
14445 {
14446 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
14447 struct symtab_and_line sal;
14448 CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc;
14449
14450 if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL)
14451 {
14452 tp->control.single_step_breakpoints
14453 = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->global_num, gdbarch);
14454 }
14455
14456 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
14457 sal.pc = pc;
14458 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
14459 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
14460 add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal);
14461
14462 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
14463 }
14464
14465 /* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state. */
14466
14467 int
14468 insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
14469 {
14470 struct regcache *regcache = get_current_regcache ();
14471 std::vector<CORE_ADDR> next_pcs;
14472
14473 next_pcs = gdbarch_software_single_step (gdbarch, regcache);
14474
14475 if (!next_pcs.empty ())
14476 {
14477 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
14478 const address_space *aspace = get_frame_address_space (frame);
14479
14480 for (CORE_ADDR pc : next_pcs)
14481 insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, pc);
14482
14483 return 1;
14484 }
14485 else
14486 return 0;
14487 }
14488
14489 /* See breakpoint.h. */
14490
14491 int
14492 breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp,
14493 const address_space *aspace,
14494 CORE_ADDR pc)
14495 {
14496 struct bp_location *loc;
14497
14498 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14499 if (loc->inserted
14500 && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
14501 return 1;
14502
14503 return 0;
14504 }
14505
14506 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
14507 PC. */
14508
14509 int
14510 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
14511 CORE_ADDR pc)
14512 {
14513 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14514
14515 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14516 {
14517 if (bpt->type == bp_single_step
14518 && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc))
14519 return 1;
14520 }
14521 return 0;
14522 }
14523
14524 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
14525
14526 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
14527 static void
14528 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
14529 {
14530 tracepoint_count = num;
14531 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
14532 }
14533
14534 static void
14535 trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14536 {
14537 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14538
14539 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14540 current_language);
14541 if (location != NULL
14542 && event_location_type (location.get ()) == PROBE_LOCATION)
14543 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
14544 else
14545 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14546
14547 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14548 location.get (),
14549 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14550 0 /* tempflag */,
14551 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14552 0 /* Ignore count */,
14553 pending_break_support,
14554 ops,
14555 from_tty,
14556 1 /* enabled */,
14557 0 /* internal */, 0);
14558 }
14559
14560 static void
14561 ftrace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14562 {
14563 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14564 current_language);
14565 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14566 location.get (),
14567 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14568 0 /* tempflag */,
14569 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14570 0 /* Ignore count */,
14571 pending_break_support,
14572 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14573 from_tty,
14574 1 /* enabled */,
14575 0 /* internal */, 0);
14576 }
14577
14578 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
14579
14580 static void
14581 strace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14582 {
14583 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14584 event_location_up location;
14585
14586 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
14587 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
14588 if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2]))
14589 {
14590 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
14591 location = new_linespec_location (&arg, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
14592 }
14593 else
14594 {
14595 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14596 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
14597 }
14598
14599 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14600 location.get (),
14601 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14602 0 /* tempflag */,
14603 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14604 0 /* Ignore count */,
14605 pending_break_support,
14606 ops,
14607 from_tty,
14608 1 /* enabled */,
14609 0 /* internal */, 0);
14610 }
14611
14612 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
14613 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
14614
14615 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
14616 static int next_cmd;
14617
14618 static char *
14619 read_uploaded_action (void)
14620 {
14621 char *rslt = nullptr;
14622
14623 if (next_cmd < this_utp->cmd_strings.size ())
14624 {
14625 rslt = this_utp->cmd_strings[next_cmd].get ();
14626 next_cmd++;
14627 }
14628
14629 return rslt;
14630 }
14631
14632 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
14633 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
14634 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
14635 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
14636 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
14637
14638 struct tracepoint *
14639 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
14640 {
14641 const char *addr_str;
14642 char small_buf[100];
14643 struct tracepoint *tp;
14644
14645 if (utp->at_string)
14646 addr_str = utp->at_string.get ();
14647 else
14648 {
14649 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
14650 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
14651 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
14652 user. */
14653 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
14654 "source location, using raw address"),
14655 utp->number);
14656 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
14657 addr_str = small_buf;
14658 }
14659
14660 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
14661 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
14662 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
14663 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
14664 utp->number);
14665
14666 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str,
14667 current_language);
14668 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14669 location.get (),
14670 utp->cond_string.get (), -1, addr_str,
14671 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
14672 0 /* tempflag */,
14673 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
14674 0 /* Ignore count */,
14675 pending_break_support,
14676 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14677 0 /* from_tty */,
14678 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
14679 0 /* internal */,
14680 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
14681 return NULL;
14682
14683 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
14684 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
14685 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
14686
14687 if (utp->pass > 0)
14688 {
14689 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
14690 tp->number);
14691
14692 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
14693 }
14694
14695 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
14696 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
14697 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
14698 function. */
14699 if (!utp->cmd_strings.empty ())
14700 {
14701 counted_command_line cmd_list;
14702
14703 this_utp = utp;
14704 next_cmd = 0;
14705
14706 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL);
14707
14708 breakpoint_set_commands (tp, std::move (cmd_list));
14709 }
14710 else if (!utp->actions.empty ()
14711 || !utp->step_actions.empty ())
14712 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
14713 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
14714 utp->number);
14715
14716 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
14717 tp->hit_count = utp->hit_count;
14718 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
14719
14720 return tp;
14721 }
14722
14723 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
14724 omitted. */
14725
14726 static void
14727 info_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14728 {
14729 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
14730 int num_printed;
14731
14732 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_tracepoint);
14733
14734 if (num_printed == 0)
14735 {
14736 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14737 uiout->message ("No tracepoints.\n");
14738 else
14739 uiout->message ("No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
14740 }
14741
14742 default_collect_info ();
14743 }
14744
14745 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
14746 Not supported by all targets. */
14747 static void
14748 enable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14749 {
14750 enable_command (args, from_tty);
14751 }
14752
14753 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
14754 Not supported by all targets. */
14755 static void
14756 disable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14757 {
14758 disable_command (args, from_tty);
14759 }
14760
14761 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
14762 static void
14763 delete_trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14764 {
14765 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14766
14767 dont_repeat ();
14768
14769 if (arg == 0)
14770 {
14771 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
14772
14773 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
14774 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
14775 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
14776 argument. */
14777 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14778 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14779 {
14780 breaks_to_delete = 1;
14781 break;
14782 }
14783
14784 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
14785 if (!from_tty
14786 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
14787 {
14788 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14789 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14790 delete_breakpoint (b);
14791 }
14792 }
14793 else
14794 map_breakpoint_numbers
14795 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
14796 {
14797 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
14798 });
14799 }
14800
14801 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
14802
14803 static void
14804 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
14805 {
14806 tp->pass_count = count;
14807 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (tp);
14808 if (from_tty)
14809 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
14810 tp->number, count);
14811 }
14812
14813 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
14814
14815 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
14816 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
14817 Also accepts special argument "all". */
14818
14819 static void
14820 trace_pass_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14821 {
14822 struct tracepoint *t1;
14823 ULONGEST count;
14824
14825 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
14826 error (_("passcount command requires an "
14827 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
14828
14829 count = strtoulst (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
14830
14831 args = skip_spaces (args);
14832 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
14833 {
14834 struct breakpoint *b;
14835
14836 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
14837 if (*args)
14838 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
14839
14840 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14841 {
14842 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14843 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14844 }
14845 }
14846 else if (*args == '\0')
14847 {
14848 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
14849 if (t1)
14850 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14851 }
14852 else
14853 {
14854 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14855 while (!parser.finished ())
14856 {
14857 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser);
14858 if (t1)
14859 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14860 }
14861 }
14862 }
14863
14864 struct tracepoint *
14865 get_tracepoint (int num)
14866 {
14867 struct breakpoint *t;
14868
14869 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
14870 if (t->number == num)
14871 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
14872
14873 return NULL;
14874 }
14875
14876 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
14877 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
14878 reconnecting). */
14879
14880 struct tracepoint *
14881 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
14882 {
14883 struct breakpoint *b;
14884
14885 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14886 {
14887 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14888
14889 if (t->number_on_target == num)
14890 return t;
14891 }
14892
14893 return NULL;
14894 }
14895
14896 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
14897 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
14898 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
14899 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
14900
14901 struct tracepoint *
14902 get_tracepoint_by_number (const char **arg,
14903 number_or_range_parser *parser)
14904 {
14905 struct breakpoint *t;
14906 int tpnum;
14907 const char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
14908
14909 if (parser != NULL)
14910 {
14911 gdb_assert (!parser->finished ());
14912 tpnum = parser->get_number ();
14913 }
14914 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
14915 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
14916 else
14917 tpnum = get_number (arg);
14918
14919 if (tpnum <= 0)
14920 {
14921 if (instring && *instring)
14922 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
14923 instring);
14924 else
14925 printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
14926 return NULL;
14927 }
14928
14929 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
14930 if (t->number == tpnum)
14931 {
14932 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
14933 }
14934
14935 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
14936 return NULL;
14937 }
14938
14939 void
14940 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
14941 {
14942 if (b->thread != -1)
14943 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
14944
14945 if (b->task != 0)
14946 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
14947
14948 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
14949 }
14950
14951 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
14952 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
14953 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
14954 non-zero. */
14955
14956 static void
14957 save_breakpoints (const char *filename, int from_tty,
14958 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
14959 {
14960 struct breakpoint *tp;
14961 int any = 0;
14962 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
14963
14964 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
14965 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
14966
14967 /* See if we have anything to save. */
14968 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
14969 {
14970 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
14971 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
14972 continue;
14973
14974 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
14975 if (filter && !filter (tp))
14976 continue;
14977
14978 any = 1;
14979
14980 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
14981 {
14982 extra_trace_bits = 1;
14983
14984 /* We can stop searching. */
14985 break;
14986 }
14987 }
14988
14989 if (!any)
14990 {
14991 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
14992 return;
14993 }
14994
14995 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> expanded_filename (tilde_expand (filename));
14996
14997 stdio_file fp;
14998
14999 if (!fp.open (expanded_filename.get (), "w"))
15000 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
15001 expanded_filename.get (), safe_strerror (errno));
15002
15003 if (extra_trace_bits)
15004 save_trace_state_variables (&fp);
15005
15006 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15007 {
15008 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15009 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15010 continue;
15011
15012 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15013 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15014 continue;
15015
15016 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, &fp);
15017
15018 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
15019 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
15020 instead. */
15021
15022 if (tp->cond_string)
15023 fp.printf (" condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
15024
15025 if (tp->ignore_count)
15026 fp.printf (" ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
15027
15028 if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
15029 {
15030 fp.puts (" commands\n");
15031
15032 current_uiout->redirect (&fp);
15033 TRY
15034 {
15035 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands.get (), 2);
15036 }
15037 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
15038 {
15039 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15040 throw_exception (ex);
15041 }
15042 END_CATCH
15043
15044 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15045 fp.puts (" end\n");
15046 }
15047
15048 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
15049 fp.puts ("disable $bpnum\n");
15050
15051 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
15052 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
15053 special, and not user visible. */
15054 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
15055 {
15056 struct bp_location *loc;
15057 int n = 1;
15058
15059 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
15060 if (!loc->enabled)
15061 fp.printf ("disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
15062 }
15063 }
15064
15065 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
15066 fp.printf ("set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
15067
15068 if (from_tty)
15069 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), expanded_filename.get ());
15070 }
15071
15072 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15073
15074 static void
15075 save_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15076 {
15077 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
15078 }
15079
15080 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
15081
15082 static void
15083 save_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15084 {
15085 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
15086 }
15087
15088 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
15089
15090 std::vector<breakpoint *>
15091 all_tracepoints (void)
15092 {
15093 std::vector<breakpoint *> tp_vec;
15094 struct breakpoint *tp;
15095
15096 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
15097 {
15098 tp_vec.push_back (tp);
15099 }
15100
15101 return tp_vec;
15102 }
15103
15104 \f
15105 /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying
15106 locations used by several commands. */
15107
15108 #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \
15109 "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\
15110 source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\
15111 Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15112 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\
15113 \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\
15114 \n\
15115 Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\
15116 program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\
15117 \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\
15118 \n\
15119 Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\
15120 syntax to specify location parameters.\n\
15121 Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15122 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\
15123 -function fact -label the_top\".\n\
15124 \n\
15125 By default, a specified function is matched against the program's\n\
15126 functions in all scopes. For C++, this means in all namespaces and\n\
15127 classes. For Ada, this means in all packages. E.g., in C++,\n\
15128 \"func()\" matches \"A::func()\", \"A::B::func()\", etc. The\n\
15129 \"-qualified\" flag overrides this behavior, making GDB interpret the\n\
15130 specified name as a complete fully-qualified name instead.\n"
15131
15132 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
15133 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
15134 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
15135 command. */
15136
15137 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
15138 command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
15139 PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
15140 probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
15141 guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\
15142 `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\
15143 LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\
15144 below.\n\
15145 \n\
15146 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
15147 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
15148 \n\
15149 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
15150 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15151 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15152 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15153 conditions are different.\n\
15154 \n\
15155 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
15156
15157 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
15158 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
15159
15160 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
15161 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
15162
15163 void
15164 add_catch_command (const char *name, const char *docstring,
15165 cmd_const_sfunc_ftype *sfunc,
15166 completer_ftype *completer,
15167 void *user_data_catch,
15168 void *user_data_tcatch)
15169 {
15170 struct cmd_list_element *command;
15171
15172 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15173 &catch_cmdlist);
15174 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15175 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
15176 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15177
15178 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15179 &tcatch_cmdlist);
15180 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15181 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
15182 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15183 }
15184
15185 static void
15186 save_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
15187 {
15188 printf_unfiltered (_("\"save\" must be followed by "
15189 "the name of a save subcommand.\n"));
15190 help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", all_commands, gdb_stdout);
15191 }
15192
15193 struct breakpoint *
15194 iterate_over_breakpoints (int (*callback) (struct breakpoint *, void *),
15195 void *data)
15196 {
15197 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15198
15199 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15200 {
15201 if ((*callback) (b, data))
15202 return b;
15203 }
15204
15205 return NULL;
15206 }
15207
15208 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
15209 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
15210
15211 static int
15212 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
15213 {
15214 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
15215 non-inline function. */
15216 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
15217 return 1;
15218
15219 return 0;
15220 }
15221
15222 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
15223 have been inlined. */
15224
15225 int
15226 pc_at_non_inline_function (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
15227 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
15228 {
15229 struct breakpoint *b;
15230 struct bp_location *bl;
15231
15232 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
15233 {
15234 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
15235 continue;
15236
15237 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
15238 {
15239 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
15240 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
15241 return 1;
15242 }
15243 }
15244
15245 return 0;
15246 }
15247
15248 /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
15249
15250 void
15251 breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
15252 {
15253 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
15254
15255 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
15256 if (loc->symtab != NULL && SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc->symtab) == objfile)
15257 loc->symtab = NULL;
15258 }
15259
15260 void
15261 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
15262 {
15263 static int initialized = 0;
15264
15265 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15266
15267 if (initialized)
15268 return;
15269 initialized = 1;
15270
15271 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
15272 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
15273 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
15274 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15275 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15276 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15277 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
15278 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
15279 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
15280 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_create_sals_from_location;
15281 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
15282 ops->decode_location = bkpt_decode_location;
15283
15284 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
15285 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15286 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15287 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15288 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15289 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15290 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15291 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
15292
15293 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
15294 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
15295 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15296 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
15297 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
15298 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
15299 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
15300 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
15301 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
15302 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
15303
15304 /* Internal breakpoints. */
15305 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
15306 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15307 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
15308 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
15309 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
15310 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
15311
15312 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
15313 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
15314 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15315 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
15316 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
15317 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
15318 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
15319
15320 /* Probe breakpoints. */
15321 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15322 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15323 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
15324 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
15325 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15326 ops->decode_location = bkpt_probe_decode_location;
15327
15328 /* Watchpoints. */
15329 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15330 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15331 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
15332 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
15333 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
15334 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
15335 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
15336 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
15337 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
15338 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
15339 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
15340 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
15341 ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
15342
15343 /* Masked watchpoints. */
15344 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15345 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15346 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
15347 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
15348 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
15349 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
15350 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
15351 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
15352 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
15353 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
15354
15355 /* Tracepoints. */
15356 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15357 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15358 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
15359 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
15360 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
15361 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
15362 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
15363 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_create_sals_from_location;
15364 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
15365 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_decode_location;
15366
15367 /* Probe tracepoints. */
15368 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15369 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15370 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15371 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_probe_decode_location;
15372
15373 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
15374 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15375 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15376 ops->create_sals_from_location = strace_marker_create_sals_from_location;
15377 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
15378 ops->decode_location = strace_marker_decode_location;
15379
15380 /* Fork catchpoints. */
15381 ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
15382 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15383 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
15384 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
15385 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
15386 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
15387 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
15388 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
15389 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
15390
15391 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
15392 ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
15393 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15394 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
15395 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
15396 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
15397 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
15398 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
15399 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
15400 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
15401
15402 /* Exec catchpoints. */
15403 ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
15404 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15405 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
15406 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
15407 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
15408 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
15409 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
15410 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
15411 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
15412
15413 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
15414 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
15415 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15416 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
15417 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
15418 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
15419 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
15420 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
15421 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
15422 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
15423 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
15424
15425 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
15426 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15427 ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
15428 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15429 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15430 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15431 ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
15432 ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
15433 ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
15434 }
15435
15436 /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
15437
15438 static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
15439
15440 /* See breakpoint.h. */
15441
15442 cmd_list_element *commands_cmd_element = nullptr;
15443
15444 void
15445 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
15446 {
15447 struct cmd_list_element *c;
15448
15449 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
15450
15451 gdb::observers::solib_unloaded.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
15452 gdb::observers::free_objfile.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile);
15453 gdb::observers::memory_changed.attach (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
15454
15455 breakpoint_objfile_key
15456 = register_objfile_data_with_cleanup (NULL, free_breakpoint_objfile_data);
15457
15458 breakpoint_chain = 0;
15459 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
15460 before a breakpoint is set. */
15461 breakpoint_count = 0;
15462
15463 tracepoint_count = 0;
15464
15465 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
15466 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
15467 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
15468
15469 commands_cmd_element = add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint,
15470 commands_command, _("\
15471 Set commands to be executed when the given breakpoints are hit.\n\
15472 Give a space-separated breakpoint list as argument after \"commands\".\n\
15473 A list element can be a breakpoint number (e.g. `5') or a range of numbers\n\
15474 (e.g. `5-7').\n\
15475 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
15476 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
15477 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
15478 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
15479 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
15480
15481 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
15482 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
15483 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
15484 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
15485 set_cmd_completer (c, condition_completer);
15486
15487 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
15488 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
15489 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15490 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
15491 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
15492 \n"
15493 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
15494 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15495
15496 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
15497 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15498 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
15499 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
15500 \n"
15501 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
15502 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15503
15504 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
15505 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15506 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15507 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
15508 \n"
15509 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
15510 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15511
15512 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15513 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15514 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15515 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
15516 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15517 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
15518 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15519
15520 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15521
15522 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15523 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15524 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15525 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15526 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
15527 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
15528
15529 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15530 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15531 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15532 &enablebreaklist);
15533
15534 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15535 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15536 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15537 &enablebreaklist);
15538
15539 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15540 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
15541 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15542 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15543 &enablebreaklist);
15544
15545 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15546 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15547 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15548 &enablelist);
15549
15550 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15551 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15552 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15553 &enablelist);
15554
15555 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15556 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
15557 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15558 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15559 &enablelist);
15560
15561 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
15562 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
15563 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15564 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15565 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
15566 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15567 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15568 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15569
15570 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
15571 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
15572 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15573 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15574 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
15575 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
15576 &disablelist);
15577
15578 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
15579 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15580 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15581 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15582 \n\
15583 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
15584 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
15585 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
15586 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15587 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15588
15589 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
15590 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15591 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15592 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15593 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
15594 &deletelist);
15595
15596 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
15597 Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\
15598 Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\
15599 \n\
15600 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
15601 is executing in.\n"
15602 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15603 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
15604 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
15605
15606 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
15607 Set breakpoint at specified location.\n"
15608 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
15609 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15610
15611 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
15612 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
15613 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
15614 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
15615
15616 if (dbx_commands)
15617 {
15618 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
15619 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
15620 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
15621 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
15622 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
15623 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
15624 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
15625 add_com ("status", class_info, info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15626 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15627 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15628 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15629 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15630 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15631 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15632 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15633 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15634 \n\
15635 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15636 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15637 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15638 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15639 breakpoint set."));
15640 }
15641
15642 add_info ("breakpoints", info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15643 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
15644 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15645 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15646 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15647 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15648 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15649 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15650 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15651 \n\
15652 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15653 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15654 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15655 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15656 breakpoint set."));
15657
15658 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
15659
15660 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
15661 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15662 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15663 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15664 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15665 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
15666 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
15667 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
15668 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
15669 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15670 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15671 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15672 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15673 \n\
15674 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15675 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15676 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15677 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15678 breakpoint set."),
15679 &maintenanceinfolist);
15680
15681 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
15682 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
15683 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
15684 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15685
15686 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
15687 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
15688 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
15689 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15690
15691 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
15692 catch_fork_command_1,
15693 NULL,
15694 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
15695 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
15696 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
15697 catch_fork_command_1,
15698 NULL,
15699 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
15700 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
15701 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
15702 catch_exec_command_1,
15703 NULL,
15704 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15705 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15706 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
15707 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
15708 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15709 catch_load_command_1,
15710 NULL,
15711 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15712 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15713 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
15714 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
15715 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15716 catch_unload_command_1,
15717 NULL,
15718 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15719 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15720
15721 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
15722 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15723 Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15724 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15725 an expression changes.\n\
15726 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15727 the memory to which it refers."));
15728 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15729
15730 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
15731 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15732 Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15733 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15734 an expression is read.\n\
15735 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15736 the memory to which it refers."));
15737 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15738
15739 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
15740 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15741 Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15742 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15743 an expression is either read or written.\n\
15744 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15745 the memory to which it refers."));
15746 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15747
15748 add_info ("watchpoints", info_watchpoints_command, _("\
15749 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
15750
15751 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
15752 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
15753 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
15754 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
15755 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15756 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15757 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
15758 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
15759 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
15760 hardware.)"),
15761 NULL,
15762 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
15763 &setlist, &showlist);
15764
15765 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
15766
15767 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
15768
15769 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
15770 Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15771 \n"
15772 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
15773 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15774 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15775
15776 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
15777 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15778 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15779 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15780
15781 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
15782 Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15783 \n"
15784 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
15785 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15786 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15787
15788 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
15789 Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\
15790 \n\
15791 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
15792 LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\
15793 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\
15794 If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\
15795 no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\
15796 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
15797 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
15798 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
15799 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
15800 \n\
15801 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15802 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15803 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15804 conditions are different.\n\
15805 \n\
15806 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
15807 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15808 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15809
15810 add_info ("tracepoints", info_tracepoints_command, _("\
15811 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
15812 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
15813 last tracepoint set."));
15814
15815 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
15816
15817 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
15818 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
15819 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15820 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
15821 &deletelist);
15822 add_alias_cmd ("tr", "tracepoints", class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
15823
15824 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
15825 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
15826 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15827 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
15828 &disablelist);
15829 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
15830
15831 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
15832 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
15833 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15834 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
15835 &enablelist);
15836 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
15837
15838 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
15839 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
15840 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
15841 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
15842 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
15843
15844 add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command,
15845 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
15846 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
15847 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15848
15849 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
15850 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
15851 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
15852 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
15853 session to restore them."),
15854 &save_cmdlist);
15855 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
15856
15857 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
15858 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
15859 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
15860 &save_cmdlist);
15861 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
15862
15863 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
15864 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
15865
15866 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
15867 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
15868 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15869 pending breakpoint behavior"),
15870 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
15871 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
15872 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
15873 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
15874 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15875 pending breakpoint behavior"),
15876 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
15877 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
15878
15879 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
15880 &pending_break_support, _("\
15881 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15882 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15883 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
15884 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
15885 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
15886 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
15887 NULL,
15888 show_pending_break_support,
15889 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15890 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15891
15892 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
15893
15894 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
15895 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
15896 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15897 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15898 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
15899 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
15900 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
15901 NULL,
15902 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
15903 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15904 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15905
15906 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
15907 &always_inserted_mode, _("\
15908 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15909 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15910 When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
15911 they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
15912 only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
15913 breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
15914 when execution stops."),
15915 NULL,
15916 &show_always_inserted_mode,
15917 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15918 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15919
15920 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
15921 condition_evaluation_enums,
15922 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
15923 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15924 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15925 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
15926 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
15927 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
15928 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
15929 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
15930 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
15931 be set to \"gdb\""),
15932 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
15933 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
15934 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15935 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15936
15937 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
15938 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
15939 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
15940 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
15941 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
15942 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
15943 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
15944 or the start of the range\n\
15945 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
15946 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
15947 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
15948 \n\
15949 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
15950 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
15951 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
15952
15953 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
15954 Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\
15955 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
15956 location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n"
15957 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING));
15958 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15959
15960 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
15961 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
15962 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
15963 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
15964 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
15965 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
15966 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
15967 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
15968 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
15969 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
15970 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
15971 &setlist, &showlist);
15972
15973 dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
15974 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
15975 &dprintf_function, _("\
15976 Set the function to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
15977 Show the function to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
15978 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
15979 &setlist, &showlist);
15980
15981 dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
15982 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
15983 &dprintf_channel, _("\
15984 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
15985 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
15986 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
15987 &setlist, &showlist);
15988
15989 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
15990 &disconnected_dprintf, _("\
15991 Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
15992 Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
15993 Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
15994 even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
15995 NULL,
15996 NULL,
15997 &setlist, &showlist);
15998
15999 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
16000 agent-printf \"printf format string\", arg1, arg2, arg3, ..., argn\n\
16001 (target agent only) This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
16002
16003 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
16004
16005 gdb::observers::about_to_proceed.attach (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
16006 gdb::observers::thread_exit.attach (remove_threaded_breakpoints);
16007 }
This page took 0.3445 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.